EP4103809A1 - Data and power network of a facility - Google Patents
Data and power network of a facilityInfo
- Publication number
- EP4103809A1 EP4103809A1 EP21752901.5A EP21752901A EP4103809A1 EP 4103809 A1 EP4103809 A1 EP 4103809A1 EP 21752901 A EP21752901 A EP 21752901A EP 4103809 A1 EP4103809 A1 EP 4103809A1
- Authority
- EP
- European Patent Office
- Prior art keywords
- communication type
- line cable
- connection
- electrical current
- direct
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Pending
Links
- 230000006854 communication Effects 0.000 claims abstract description 714
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 claims abstract description 714
- 238000009826 distribution Methods 0.000 claims description 400
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 claims description 126
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 claims description 75
- 238000007726 management method Methods 0.000 claims description 19
- 238000012544 monitoring process Methods 0.000 claims description 17
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 claims description 16
- 238000010801 machine learning Methods 0.000 claims description 14
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 claims description 14
- 238000012913 prioritisation Methods 0.000 claims description 13
- 230000004913 activation Effects 0.000 claims description 8
- 238000004590 computer program Methods 0.000 claims description 7
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 claims description 4
- 230000009365 direct transmission Effects 0.000 claims description 2
- 238000009472 formulation Methods 0.000 claims description 2
- 239000010410 layer Substances 0.000 description 65
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 57
- 230000003287 optical effect Effects 0.000 description 49
- 239000000835 fiber Substances 0.000 description 47
- 230000001413 cellular effect Effects 0.000 description 42
- 230000001276 controlling effect Effects 0.000 description 41
- 230000000903 blocking effect Effects 0.000 description 38
- 239000003990 capacitor Substances 0.000 description 38
- 239000007789 gas Substances 0.000 description 38
- 230000010267 cellular communication Effects 0.000 description 35
- 230000007704 transition Effects 0.000 description 35
- 230000008878 coupling Effects 0.000 description 33
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 description 33
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 description 33
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 32
- 239000013307 optical fiber Substances 0.000 description 30
- 239000004984 smart glass Substances 0.000 description 30
- 125000006850 spacer group Chemical group 0.000 description 24
- 150000002500 ions Chemical class 0.000 description 23
- 238000012545 processing Methods 0.000 description 23
- 238000011144 upstream manufacturing Methods 0.000 description 21
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 description 20
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 19
- 239000011521 glass Substances 0.000 description 19
- 230000001105 regulatory effect Effects 0.000 description 19
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 description 19
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 16
- 239000004020 conductor Substances 0.000 description 16
- 238000010438 heat treatment Methods 0.000 description 16
- 238000009434 installation Methods 0.000 description 16
- 238000000576 coating method Methods 0.000 description 15
- 238000005516 engineering process Methods 0.000 description 15
- 230000007613 environmental effect Effects 0.000 description 13
- 230000002441 reversible effect Effects 0.000 description 13
- 238000001228 spectrum Methods 0.000 description 13
- 238000004378 air conditioning Methods 0.000 description 12
- 239000011248 coating agent Substances 0.000 description 12
- 239000007787 solid Substances 0.000 description 12
- 238000009423 ventilation Methods 0.000 description 12
- -1 blocks (e.g. Substances 0.000 description 11
- 238000005259 measurement Methods 0.000 description 11
- 230000006855 networking Effects 0.000 description 11
- 238000003860 storage Methods 0.000 description 11
- 238000004804 winding Methods 0.000 description 11
- CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbon dioxide Chemical compound O=C=O CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- 230000007175 bidirectional communication Effects 0.000 description 10
- 238000013461 design Methods 0.000 description 10
- 230000002687 intercalation Effects 0.000 description 10
- 238000009830 intercalation Methods 0.000 description 10
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 description 9
- 230000009467 reduction Effects 0.000 description 9
- 150000001768 cations Chemical class 0.000 description 8
- 239000012855 volatile organic compound Substances 0.000 description 8
- 230000002238 attenuated effect Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000010276 construction Methods 0.000 description 7
- 238000002347 injection Methods 0.000 description 7
- 239000007924 injection Substances 0.000 description 7
- 239000007788 liquid Substances 0.000 description 7
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 7
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 7
- 239000002245 particle Substances 0.000 description 7
- 239000004033 plastic Substances 0.000 description 7
- 229920003023 plastic Polymers 0.000 description 7
- 230000001902 propagating effect Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000013473 artificial intelligence Methods 0.000 description 6
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 6
- 238000011065 in-situ storage Methods 0.000 description 6
- 230000000670 limiting effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 239000004973 liquid crystal related substance Substances 0.000 description 6
- 229910001416 lithium ion Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 239000000047 product Substances 0.000 description 6
- IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N Atomic nitrogen Chemical compound N#N IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 239000002585 base Substances 0.000 description 5
- 229910002092 carbon dioxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 5
- 239000001569 carbon dioxide Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000037431 insertion Effects 0.000 description 5
- 238000009413 insulation Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000007257 malfunction Effects 0.000 description 5
- 229920000642 polymer Polymers 0.000 description 5
- 239000013589 supplement Substances 0.000 description 5
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Chemical compound O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- XKRFYHLGVUSROY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Argon Chemical compound [Ar] XKRFYHLGVUSROY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- HBBGRARXTFLTSG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Lithium ion Chemical compound [Li+] HBBGRARXTFLTSG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicium dioxide Chemical compound O=[Si]=O VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N atomic oxygen Chemical compound [O] QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 239000000919 ceramic Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000004040 coloring Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000011960 computer-aided design Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000013016 damping Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000009429 electrical wiring Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000005670 electromagnetic radiation Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000009432 framing Methods 0.000 description 4
- 239000011261 inert gas Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000010416 ion conductor Substances 0.000 description 4
- QGLKJKCYBOYXKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N nonaoxidotritungsten Chemical compound O=[W]1(=O)O[W](=O)(=O)O[W](=O)(=O)O1 QGLKJKCYBOYXKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 239000011368 organic material Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000001301 oxygen Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910052760 oxygen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 230000002829 reductive effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000000565 sealant Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000004065 semiconductor Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000012549 training Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229910001930 tungsten oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 239000004606 Fillers/Extenders Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000015556 catabolic process Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000013500 data storage Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000006731 degradation reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000003111 delayed effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000000428 dust Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000007772 electrode material Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000004313 glare Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229910001092 metal group alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 229910052757 nitrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 239000004417 polycarbonate Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000008093 supporting effect Effects 0.000 description 3
- 229910000859 α-Fe Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Copper Chemical compound [Cu] RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229920002367 Polyisobutene Polymers 0.000 description 2
- XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicon Chemical compound [Si] XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910000831 Steel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- PPBRXRYQALVLMV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Styrene Chemical compound C=CC1=CC=CC=C1 PPBRXRYQALVLMV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 101150071882 US17 gene Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 230000001133 acceleration Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000000853 adhesive Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000001070 adhesive effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000004075 alteration Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229910052782 aluminium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminium Chemical compound [Al] XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000004458 analytical method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000003667 anti-reflective effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229910052786 argon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 230000002457 bidirectional effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000009435 building construction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000004364 calculation method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000005229 chemical vapour deposition Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000001816 cooling Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000000151 deposition Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000003292 diminished effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005265 energy consumption Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000000284 extract Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000011888 foil Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000499 gel Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000001257 hydrogen Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052739 hydrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 238000003384 imaging method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000010348 incorporation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001939 inductive effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229910010272 inorganic material Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000011147 inorganic material Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000012212 insulator Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000001788 irregular Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000002427 irreversible effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000012986 modification Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000007935 neutral effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 150000004767 nitrides Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 239000005416 organic matter Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000010355 oscillation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000036961 partial effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000149 penetrating effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000704 physical effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000005240 physical vapour deposition Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229920002285 poly(styrene-co-acrylonitrile) Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920002635 polyurethane Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000004814 polyurethane Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000011241 protective layer Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000001012 protector Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229910052704 radon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- SYUHGPGVQRZVTB-UHFFFAOYSA-N radon atom Chemical compound [Rn] SYUHGPGVQRZVTB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000011150 reinforced concrete Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000011347 resin Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920005989 resin Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 238000010079 rubber tapping Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000007789 sealing Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000000926 separation method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000035939 shock Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000011664 signaling Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229910052710 silicon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000010703 silicon Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052814 silicon oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 238000004088 simulation Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000010959 steel Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000005728 strengthening Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000006467 substitution reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001960 triggered effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- NNWNNQTUZYVQRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 5-bromo-1h-pyrrolo[2,3-c]pyridine-2-carboxylic acid Chemical compound BrC1=NC=C2NC(C(=O)O)=CC2=C1 NNWNNQTUZYVQRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920002574 CR-39 Polymers 0.000 description 1
- OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbon Chemical compound [C] OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UGFAIRIUMAVXCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbon monoxide Chemical compound [O+]#[C-] UGFAIRIUMAVXCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RWSOTUBLDIXVET-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dihydrogen sulfide Chemical compound S RWSOTUBLDIXVET-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KKCBUQHMOMHUOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Na2O Inorganic materials [O-2].[Na+].[Na+] KKCBUQHMOMHUOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004952 Polyamide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004793 Polystyrene Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004809 Teflon Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920006362 Teflon® Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 101150013568 US16 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101150049278 US20 gene Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000002835 absorbance Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010521 absorption reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003213 activating effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000654 additive Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003513 alkali Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910000272 alkali metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910000287 alkaline earth metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000003321 amplification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000005328 architectural glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003491 array Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000010425 asbestos Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910002113 barium titanate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000003796 beauty Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000006399 behavior Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000033228 biological regulation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011449 brick Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004422 calculation algorithm Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052799 carbon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910002091 carbon monoxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000012512 characterization method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003818 cinder Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004927 clay Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000008867 communication pathway Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002131 composite material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004567 concrete Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003750 conditioning effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000008602 contraction Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910052802 copper Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000010949 copper Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000007797 corrosion Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000005260 corrosion Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000001419 dependent effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003467 diminishing effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000006073 displacement reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005315 distribution function Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010616 electrical installation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000005672 electromagnetic field Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003344 environmental pollutant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000011152 fibreglass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001914 filtration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000005329 float glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000004907 flux Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000006260 foam Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000010440 gypsum Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052602 gypsum Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000001475 halogen functional group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000036541 health Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000002837 heart atrium Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229910000037 hydrogen sulfide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000001976 improved effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011810 insulating material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052743 krypton Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- DNNSSWSSYDEUBZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N krypton atom Chemical compound [Kr] DNNSSWSSYDEUBZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000007774 longterm Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000012423 maintenance Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000003340 mental effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910044991 metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000004706 metal oxides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000012806 monitoring device Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000005404 monopole Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002070 nanowire Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052756 noble gas Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- VIKNJXKGJWUCNN-XGXHKTLJSA-N norethisterone Chemical compound O=C1CC[C@@H]2[C@H]3CC[C@](C)([C@](CC4)(O)C#C)[C@@H]4[C@@H]3CCC2=C1 VIKNJXKGJWUCNN-XGXHKTLJSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000003199 nucleic acid amplification method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010943 off-gassing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000013021 overheating Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005192 partition Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000035515 penetration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011505 plaster Substances 0.000 description 1
- 231100000719 pollutant Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 229920003229 poly(methyl methacrylate) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920002647 polyamide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000515 polycarbonate Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000728 polyester Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000004926 polymethyl methacrylate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000306 polymethylpentene Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000011116 polymethylpentene Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920001296 polysiloxane Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920002223 polystyrene Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000000843 powder Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000644 propagated effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000010453 quartz Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000002310 reflectometry Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000009877 rendering Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000009418 renovation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052895 riebeckite Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229920006395 saturated elastomer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910052709 silver Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000004332 silver Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000010454 slate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000005361 soda-lime glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000003595 spectral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000004575 stone Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005496 tempering Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012815 thermoplastic material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000002604 ultrasonography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052720 vanadium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000013022 venting Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000012795 verification Methods 0.000 description 1
- WDQKVWDSAIJUTF-GPENDAJRSA-N via protocol Chemical compound ClCCNP1(=O)OCCCN1CCCl.O([C@H]1C[C@@](O)(CC=2C(O)=C3C(=O)C=4C=CC=C(C=4C(=O)C3=C(O)C=21)OC)C(=O)CO)[C@H]1C[C@H](N)[C@H](O)[C@H](C)O1.C([C@H](C[C@]1(C(=O)OC)C=2C(=C3C([C@]45[C@H]([C@@]([C@H](OC(C)=O)[C@]6(CC)C=CCN([C@H]56)CC4)(O)C(=O)OC)N3C=O)=CC=2)OC)C[C@@](C2)(O)CC)N2CCC2=C1NC1=CC=CC=C21 WDQKVWDSAIJUTF-GPENDAJRSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000000391 vinyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])=C([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 229920002554 vinyl polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000001429 visible spectrum Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002023 wood Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052724 xenon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- FHNFHKCVQCLJFQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N xenon atom Chemical compound [Xe] FHNFHKCVQCLJFQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04L—TRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
- H04L12/00—Data switching networks
- H04L12/28—Data switching networks characterised by path configuration, e.g. LAN [Local Area Networks] or WAN [Wide Area Networks]
- H04L12/40—Bus networks
- H04L12/407—Bus networks with decentralised control
- H04L12/413—Bus networks with decentralised control with random access, e.g. carrier-sense multiple-access with collision detection [CSMA-CD]
-
- E—FIXED CONSTRUCTIONS
- E06—DOORS, WINDOWS, SHUTTERS, OR ROLLER BLINDS IN GENERAL; LADDERS
- E06B—FIXED OR MOVABLE CLOSURES FOR OPENINGS IN BUILDINGS, VEHICLES, FENCES OR LIKE ENCLOSURES IN GENERAL, e.g. DOORS, WINDOWS, BLINDS, GATES
- E06B9/00—Screening or protective devices for wall or similar openings, with or without operating or securing mechanisms; Closures of similar construction
- E06B9/24—Screens or other constructions affording protection against light, especially against sunshine; Similar screens for privacy or appearance; Slat blinds
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04B—TRANSMISSION
- H04B3/00—Line transmission systems
- H04B3/54—Systems for transmission via power distribution lines
- H04B3/548—Systems for transmission via power distribution lines the power on the line being DC
-
- E—FIXED CONSTRUCTIONS
- E06—DOORS, WINDOWS, SHUTTERS, OR ROLLER BLINDS IN GENERAL; LADDERS
- E06B—FIXED OR MOVABLE CLOSURES FOR OPENINGS IN BUILDINGS, VEHICLES, FENCES OR LIKE ENCLOSURES IN GENERAL, e.g. DOORS, WINDOWS, BLINDS, GATES
- E06B9/00—Screening or protective devices for wall or similar openings, with or without operating or securing mechanisms; Closures of similar construction
- E06B9/24—Screens or other constructions affording protection against light, especially against sunshine; Similar screens for privacy or appearance; Slat blinds
- E06B2009/2464—Screens or other constructions affording protection against light, especially against sunshine; Similar screens for privacy or appearance; Slat blinds featuring transparency control by applying voltage, e.g. LCD, electrochromic panels
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G02—OPTICS
- G02F—OPTICAL DEVICES OR ARRANGEMENTS FOR THE CONTROL OF LIGHT BY MODIFICATION OF THE OPTICAL PROPERTIES OF THE MEDIA OF THE ELEMENTS INVOLVED THEREIN; NON-LINEAR OPTICS; FREQUENCY-CHANGING OF LIGHT; OPTICAL LOGIC ELEMENTS; OPTICAL ANALOGUE/DIGITAL CONVERTERS
- G02F1/00—Devices or arrangements for the control of the intensity, colour, phase, polarisation or direction of light arriving from an independent light source, e.g. switching, gating or modulating; Non-linear optics
- G02F1/01—Devices or arrangements for the control of the intensity, colour, phase, polarisation or direction of light arriving from an independent light source, e.g. switching, gating or modulating; Non-linear optics for the control of the intensity, phase, polarisation or colour
- G02F1/15—Devices or arrangements for the control of the intensity, colour, phase, polarisation or direction of light arriving from an independent light source, e.g. switching, gating or modulating; Non-linear optics for the control of the intensity, phase, polarisation or colour based on an electrochromic effect
- G02F1/163—Operation of electrochromic cells, e.g. electrodeposition cells; Circuit arrangements therefor
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H04—ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
- H04B—TRANSMISSION
- H04B2203/00—Indexing scheme relating to line transmission systems
- H04B2203/54—Aspects of powerline communications not already covered by H04B3/54 and its subgroups
- H04B2203/5429—Applications for powerline communications
Definitions
- facilities e.g., buildings
- wired networks may not only allow transmission of wireless signals, but may also facilitate such transmission and/or facilitate robust wired networks.
- wireless connectivity moves to higher frequency carrier bands (e.g., such as is the case with fifth generation (5G) wireless networking) and/or as the physical infrastructure of facilities (e.g., buildings) becomes increasingly network connected.
- higher frequency carrier bands e.g., such as is the case with fifth generation (5G) wireless networking
- 5G fifth generation
- a cable network that individually addresses a plurality of centrally controlled targets can be complex and expensive to materialize as the number of targets it is communicatively coupled to increase.
- the targets can be of different types (e.g., sensor, antenna, output device and/or tintable window, e.g., comprising an optically switchable device).
- the complexity of the cable network may escalate further when the network is requested to facilitate streaming a plurality of functionalities (e.g., voice, image, data, and/or electrical current), to and/or from those targets.
- a target e.g., third party device
- it may cause the network to collapse or otherwise malfunction (e.g., due to excessive (e.g., electrical) power consumption).
- the cable system becomes lengthy and/or includes a plurality of junctions (e.g., nodes)
- a signal transmitted through this network may be prone to damping such that it may drown in the noise and not be decipherable (e.g., it may degrade as it propagates along the network).
- Some signals e.g., 5G signals
- enclosures e.g., facilities such as buildings
- the cable network can become more extensive and/or complex as a number, span, and/or volume of: (e.g., parallel) cable lines, targets, data, communication, and/or electrical power distribution, increases.
- distribution of electrical power comprises distribution of any of the electrical power components, e.g., distribution of electrical current. Therefore, a network having conventional cabling type and topology may become expensive and/or unsuitable for such high-density applications.
- the present disclosure provides systems, apparatuses, and/or non-transitory computer-readable medium (e.g., software) that facilitate wired and/or wireless connectivity within an enclosure.
- non-transitory computer-readable medium e.g., software
- a single stream type can be confined to one or more (e.g., distinguishable) frequency windows.
- Power to the targets can be controlled (e.g., managed and/or restricted).
- the targets may be identified, and optionally their identity may be verified (e.g. via blockchain) before being fully connected to the communication network that includes the cabling.
- the nodes communicatively coupled to the network and/or cable architecture of the network cabling may be designed to preserve and/or enhance the intensity of the signal transmitted through the network.
- the cable network may facilitate signal transmitted from an external environment to the enclosure into an internal enclosure environment and vice versa, e.g., by using external and internal antennas.
- the system can include a direct current (abbreviated herein as “DC”) power distributer, a repeater, range extender, and/or signal transponder.
- DC direct current
- Examples of blockchain usage, identification, security, and control systems can be found in U.S. Provisional Patent Application Serial Number 62/858,634, filed June 7, 2019, entitled, “SECURE BUILDING SERVICES NETWORK,” that is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- a system for power and communication transmission in a facility comprises: (a) a cabling system having a cable configured to transmit electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device of the facility, and a second communication type configured for media communication, which cabling system is configured to operatively couple to the at least one device; (b) a first antenna configured to receive signals of the second communication type external to the facility and transmit signals of the second communication type externally to the facility, which first antenna is operatively coupled to the cabling system; (c) a second antenna configured to (i) receive signals of the second communication type internal to the facility, and (ii) transmit signals of the second communication type internally in the facility, which second antenna is operatively coupled to the cabling system; and (d) at least one controller operatively coupled to the cabling system and configured to control the at least one device using the first communication type.
- the cable is configured to simultaneously transmit electrical current, the first communication type, and the second communication type.
- the first communication type and the second communication type have no overlapping signal frequencies.
- the first communication type is in one frequency window.
- the first communication type comprises a plurality of frequency windows.
- the second communication type is in one frequency window.
- the second communication type comprises a plurality of frequency windows.
- the cabling system is operatively coupled to one or more signal frequency filters. In some embodiments, the cabling system is operatively coupled to one or more signal amplifiers and/or repeaters.
- the second communication type comprises fourth generation (4G) and/or fifth generation (5G) cellular communication.
- the second communication type comprises analog radio-frequency signals.
- the first antenna is a directional antenna.
- the second antenna is part of a distributed antenna system.
- the second antenna is disposed in one of a plurality of edge distribution frame devices disposed in the facility.
- the electrical current is a direct current.
- electrical current directed to the at least one device is at most about 48 volts direct current.
- the cable of the cabling system is a coaxial cable.
- the cabling system comprises an optical cable.
- the facility comprises floors and wherein the cabling system comprises an optical cable that transits the first communication type and/or the second communication type between the floors. In some embodiments, the facility comprises a plurality of control panels and wherein the cabling system comprises an optical cable that transits the first communication type and/or the second communication type between the plurality of control panels. In some embodiments, the cabling system comprises a distribution junction. In some embodiments, the distribution junction distributes the power unevenly. In some embodiments, the distribution junction distributes the first communication type and/or second communication type unevenly. In some embodiments, the distribution junction is passive. In some embodiments, the distribution junction comprises an active element. In some embodiments, the active element is a controller.
- the at least one controller is configured to generate the first communication type. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is configured to operatively couple to a building management system. In some embodiments, the first communication type is generated and/or utilized by the at least one device. In some embodiments, the at least one device comprises a sensor, emitter, antenna, tintable window, lighting, security system, heating ventilation and air conditioning system (HVAC). In some embodiments, the sensor is sensitive to movement. In some embodiments, the sensor comprises an accelerometer. In some embodiments, the emitter comprises a light emitter or a sound emitter. In some embodiments, the sensor comprises an infrared, ultraviolet, or visible light sensor.
- HVAC heating ventilation and air conditioning system
- the senor is sensitive to at least one environmental characteristic comprising humidity, carbon dioxide, temperature, sound, electromagnetic, volatile organic compound, or pressure. In some embodiments, the sensor comprises a gas sensor sensitive to gas type, movement, and/or pressure. In some embodiments, the device is part of a device ensemble comprising one or more devices enclosed in a housing. In some embodiments, the one or more devices comprise at least two devices of the same type. In some embodiments, the one or more devices comprise at least two devices that are of different types. In some embodiments, the facility is a multi-story building. In some embodiments, the cabling system services at least a portion of the multi-story building. In some embodiments, the multi-story building is a skyscraper.
- a method of power and communication transmission in a facility comprises: performing at least one operation using any of the systems disclosed above.
- an apparatus for power and communication transmission in a facility comprising at least one controller configured to operatively couple to the system and perform, or direct performance of, at least one operation using any of the systems disclosed above.
- the at least one controller comprises circuitry.
- at least two of the at least one operation is performed by the same controller of the at least one controller.
- at least two of the at least one operation is performed by different controllers of the at least one controller.
- a non-transitory computer readable program product for power and communication transmission in a facility, the non-transitory computer program product containing instructions inscribed thereon which, when executed by one or more processors, cause the one or more processors to execute at least one operation using any of the systems disclosed above.
- the one or more processors are operatively coupled to the system.
- at least two of the at least one operation is executed by the same processor of the one or more processors.
- at least two of the at least one operation is executed by different processors of the one or more processors.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable medium.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non- transitory computer readable media.
- the apparatus comprises at least one controller having a circuitry, which at least one controller is configured to: (a) couple to a cabling system having a cable configured to transmit electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, which cabling system is configured to operatively couple to the at least one device; (b) couple to a first antenna configured to receive signals of the second communication type external to the facility and transmit signals of the second communication type externally to the facility; (c) couple to a second antenna configured to receive signals of the second communication type internal to the facility and transmit signals of the second communication type internally in the facility; (d) direct the second communication type from the first antenna to the second antenna; direct the second communication type from the second antenna to the first antenna; operatively couple to the at least one device of the facility; and (e
- the at least one controller comprises circuitry. In some embodiments, at least two of (a) to (e) are performed by the same controller of the at least one controller. In some embodiments, at least two of (a) to (e) are performed by different controllers of the at least one controller.
- a non-transitory computer readable program product for controlling at least one device of a facility having instructions that, when read by at least one processor, cause the at least one processor to execute operations comprises: (a) transmitting, or directing transmission, through a cable electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, which cable is part of a cabling system to which the at least one device is operatively coupled; (b) directing signals of the second communication type received by a first antenna to a second antenna and received by the second antenna to the first antenna, which first antenna is configured to receive signals of the second communication type external to the facility and transmit signals of the second communication type externally to the facility, which second antenna configured to receive signals of the second communication type internal to the facility and transmit signals of the second communication type internally in the facility; and (c) controlling, or directing control of, the at least one device by using the first communication type.
- the one or more processors are operatively coupled to the cabling system. In some embodiments, at least two of the operation are executed by the same processor of the one or more processors. In some embodiments, at least two of the operation are executed by different processors of the one or more processors.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non- transitory computer readable medium. In some embodiments, the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable media.
- a method for controlling at least one device of a facility comprises: (a) transmitting through a cable (i) an electrical current, (ii) a first communication type utilized for control of the at least one device, and (iii) a second communication type configured for media communication, which cable is part of a cabling system to which the at least one device is operatively coupled; (b) directing signals of the second communication type received by a first antenna to a second antenna, and received by the second antenna to the first antenna, which first antenna is configured to receive signals of the second communication type external to the facility and transmit signals of the second communication type externally to the facility, which second antenna configured to receive signals of the second communication type internal to the facility and transmit signals of the second communication type internally in the facility; and (c) controlling the at least one device by using the first communication type.
- the method further comprises simultaneously transmitting the electrical current, the first communication type, and the second communication type, on the cable. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the first communication type and the second communication type such that the first communication type has no overlapping signal frequencies with the second communication type. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the first communication type in one frequency window. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the first communication type in a plurality of frequency windows. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the second communication type in one frequency window. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the second communication type in a plurality of frequency windows.
- the method further comprises operatively coupling the cabling system to one or more signal frequency filters. In some embodiments, the method further comprises operatively coupling the cabling system to one or more signal amplifiers and/or repeaters. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the second communication type as a fourth generation (4G) and/or fifth generation (5G) cellular communication. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the second communication type as analog radio-frequency signals. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the first antenna as a directional antenna. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the second antenna as a part of a distributed antenna system.
- 4G fourth generation
- 5G fifth generation
- the method further comprises disposing the second antenna in one of a plurality of edge distribution frame devices disposed in the facility. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the electrical current as a direct current. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the electrical current as a direct current of at most about 48 volts. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the cable of the cabling system as a coaxial cable. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the cabling system that includes an optical cable. In some embodiments, the facility comprises floors.
- the method further comprises providing and/or using the cabling system that includes an optical cable that is configured to transmit (i) the first communication type and/or (ii) the second communication type, between the floors.
- the facility comprises a plurality of control panels.
- the method further comprises providing and/or using the cabling system that includes an optical cable that is configured to transmit (i) the first communication type and/or (ii) the second communication type, between the plurality of control panels.
- the method further comprises providing and/or using a distribution junction as part of the cabling system. In some embodiments, the method further comprises the distribution junction distributing the power unevenly.
- the method further comprises the distribution junction distributing the first communication type and/or second communication type unevenly. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the distribution junction as a passive element. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the distribution junction as an active element. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the active element as a controller. In some embodiments, the cabling system is operatively coupled to a building management system. In some embodiments, the method further comprises generating and/or utilizing the first communication type by the at least one device.
- the method further comprises providing and/or using the at least one device that includes a sensor, emitter, antenna, tintable window, lighting, security system, a heating ventilation and air conditioning system (HVAC), or any combination or plurality thereof.
- the sensor is configured to sense movement.
- the sensor comprises an accelerometer.
- the emitter comprises a light emitter or a sound emitter.
- the sensor comprises an infrared, an ultraviolet, or a visible light sensor.
- the method further comprises wherein the sensor is configured to sense at least one environmental characteristic comprising humidity, carbon dioxide, temperature, sound, electromagnetic, volatile organic compound, or pressure.
- the sensor comprises a gas sensor sensitive to: gas type, movement, and/or pressure.
- the method further comprises configuring the device to be part of a device ensemble comprising one or more devices enclosed in a housing. In some embodiments, the method further comprises configuring the one or more devices to be at least two devices of the same type. In some embodiments, the method further comprises configuring the one or more devices to be at least two devices of a different type. In some embodiments, the method further comprises configuring the facility to be a multi-story building. In some embodiments, the method further comprises configuring the cabling system to service at least a portion of the multi-story building. In some embodiments, the multi-story building is a skyscraper. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the cabling system as a trunk line cable. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using a distribution junction configured for operatively coupling the trunk line cable to a branch line cable.
- an apparatus for controlling at least one device of a facility comprises at least one controller having a circuitry, which at least one controller is configured to: (i) operatively couple to a cabling system comprising: a trunk line cable configured to transmit electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a branch line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device; a distribution junction comprising a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which junction is configured to: (a) couple along the trunk line cable by the first connection and by the second connection, (b) couple to the branch line by the third connection, (c) direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (d) direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (e)
- the at least one controller is configured to receive, or direct receipt of, an electrical power request (e.g., electrical current request) from the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to receive, or direct receipt of, an electrical power requirement (e.g., electrical current requirement) from the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable to the at least one device, which electrical current is transmitted through the distribution junction. In some embodiments, transmission of the electrical current through the distribution junction is conducted without control of the at least one controller.
- the distribution junction is configured to be not controlled by a first controller configured to control: (i) the electrical current, (ii) the first communication type, (iii) the second communication type, or (iv) any combination thereof.
- the distribution junction is controlled by a second controller different than the first controller.
- the distribution junction is not controlled by a controller.
- the distribution junction is passive.
- the distribution junction comprises a controller that controls (i) the electrical current, (ii) the first communication type, and/or (iii) the second communication type, transmitted through the distribution junction.
- the distribution junction is active.
- the at least one controller is configured to control the directed electrical current in response to the electrical power requirement (e.g., electrical current requirement) received from the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to formulate, or direct formulation of, a time schedule for operation of the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to determine, or direct determination of, a duration of time it will take for a given process to occur on the device.
- the at least one controller is configured to determine, or direct determination of, when the at least one device is required to operate In some embodiments, the at least one controller is configured to determine, or direct determination of, (i) an operational mode, (ii) a scheme for the at least one device, or (iii) any combination or plurality thereof. In some embodiments, the determination is based at least in part on operation of at least one other device operatively coupled to the network. In some embodiments, the operational mode comprises continuous operation and/or intermittent operation. In some embodiments, the at least one device includes a first device having a first operational mode and a second device having a second operational mode, and the at least one controller is configured to interlace, or direct interlacing of, the first and second operational modes.
- the at least one device includes a first device configured to issue a first request, and a second device configured to issue a second request, and wherein the at least one controller is configured to interlace, or direct interlacing of, the first request and the second request.
- the at least one device is a third-party device.
- the at least one controller is configured to manage, or direct managing of, the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to operate, or direct operation of, the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to identify, or direct identification of, how the at least one controller is operatively coupled (i) to a channel of a plurality of channels, and/or (ii) to a device of the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to prioritize, or direct prioritization of, a power budget for the at least one device and/or the channel according to a logic.
- the logic comprises business logic.
- the logic comprises a spatial designation.
- the spatial designation comprises a prioritization of spaces of the facility.
- the spatial designation comprises a space of a kind (e.g., of a type).
- the spatial designation comprises a space having at least one characteristic comprising a height, a width, a length, a floor area, a volume, a temperature, a humidity level, a pollutant level, a radon level, a particulate level, a carbon dioxide level, a volatile organic compounds (VOCs) level, a pollen level, a residential space, a commercial space, an office space, a space comprising one or more cubicles, a dining space, a living space, a bedroom space, a garage, a factory, a basement, a storage area, a rest room, a closet, a hallway, a corridor, a windowless space, a space having one or more windows, a space having an exterior wall, a space having only interior walls, a thermally insulated space, a thermally uninsulated space, an acoustically insulated space, an acoustically uninsulated space, or any combination thereof.
- VOCs volatile organic compounds
- the spatial designation comprises an occupancy level.
- the at least one controller is configured to determine, or direct determination of, the occupancy level by using at least one occupancy sensor.
- the at least one occupancy sensor comprises a geolocation, infrared, or visible sensor.
- the geolocation sensor is configured to detect electromagnetic radiation comprising ultra-wideband (UWB) radio waves, ultra-high frequency (UHF) radio waves, or radio waves utilized in global positioning system (GPS).
- the at least one controller is configured to determine, or direct determination of, the occupancy level based at least in part on deadreckoning.
- the spatial designation comprises an occupancy zone.
- the logic comprises a schedule, or one or more external conditions external to the facility.
- the logic comprises (i) a device specification (ii) a device power request, (iii) a device power requirement for the at least one device, (iv) a power request from the at least one device, (v) a predicted power usage by the at least one device, (vi) machine learning (ML), (vii) one or more scheduling constraints, (vii) historical data, (viii) product management, or (ix) one or more reasonable inferences.
- the device power requirement specifies one or more specifications comprising (i) an amount of power, (ii) a delivery time for the power, or (iii) a delivery duration for the power.
- the at least one controller is configured to use, or direct usage of, the power budget prioritization to generate a power distribution scheme for the channel of the plurality of channels, and/or the device of the at least one device.
- the at least one controller is configured to distribute, or direct distribution of, electrical power (e.g., electrical current) to the channel of the plurality of channels and/or the device of the at least one device.
- the at least one device comprises a plurality of devices, and the at least one controller is configured to define, or direct defining of, a priority listing of devices for electrical power usage among the plurality of devices.
- the at least one controller is configured to monitor, or direct monitoring of, electrical power distribution to the plurality of devices, and wherein the plurality of devices is coupled to a network. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is configured to receive, or direct receipt of, an electrical power (e.g., electrical current) budget request from one or more of the plurality of devices.
- an electrical power e.g., electrical current
- the at least one controller is configured to consider, or direct consideration of, (i) the electrical power budget request, (ii) the electrical power budget request and any other power budget request, (iii) a distribution status of the electrical power in the network, (iv) a distribution projection of the electrical power in the network at a future time, (v) a historic power usage of any of the plurality of devices in the network, (vi) power usage trends of any of the plurality of devices, or (vii) any combination or plurality thereof.
- the at least one controller is configured to generate, or direct generation of, a result pertaining to the power distribution of a device of the plurality of devices from which the at least one controller received the electrical power budget request.
- the at least one controller is configured to intermittently supply, or direct intermittent supply of, electrical power to the device of the plurality of devices from which the at least one controller received the electrical power budget request.
- the intermittent supply comprises regular (e.g., repeating) intervals.
- the intermittent supply comprises irregular (e.g., non-repeating) intervals.
- the at least one controller is configured to delay, or direct delay of, a continuous supply of electrical power (e.g., electrical current) to the device of the plurality of devices from which the at least one controller received the electrical power budget request.
- the at least one controller is configured to disconnect, or direct disconnection of, a device of the plurality of devices in response to detecting that the device is draining electrical power above a threshold value. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is configured to terminate, or direct termination of, the second communication type to a device of the plurality of devices in response to detecting that the device is utilizing electrical power above a threshold value. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is configured to remove, or direct removal of, at least a portion of the electrical power from a device of the plurality of devices in response to detecting that the device is utilizing electrical power above a threshold value. In some embodiments, the priority listing is based at least in part on business logic.
- the electrical power budget request is for an altered power budget.
- the power usage trends are determined based at least in part on Machine Learning.
- the at least one controller is operatively coupled to a network to which one or more tintable windows are operatively coupled to.
- the at least one controller is configured to generate, or direct generation of, a model using one or more operational modes for the tintable windows.
- the one or more operational modes include a transition of the one or more tintable windows.
- the one or more operational modes comprise Artificial Intelligence or Machine Learning.
- the at least one controller is configured to gather, or direct gathering of, information to generate a training set. In some embodiments, the information gathered comprises historical measurements.
- the historical measurements are of the facility. In some embodiments, the historical measurements are of another facility. In some embodiments, the gathered information comprises synthesized measurements. In some embodiments, the gathered information is gathered from software and/or hardware of a local controller. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is configured to use, or direct utilization of, the training set to predict electrical power usage of the at least one device at a future time. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is configured to deliver, or direct delivery of, electrical power to the at least one device based at least in part on the prediction of the electrical power (e.g., electrical current) usage of the at least one device at the future time. In some embodiments, the at least one controller comprises circuitry.
- At least two of (a) to (h) are performed by the same controller of the at least one controller. In some embodiments, at least two of (a) to (h) are performed by different controllers of the at least one controller. [0019] In another aspect, a method of controlling at least one device of a facility, the method comprising performing at least one operation using operations of any of the at least one controller disclosed above.
- a non-transitory computer readable program product for controlling at least one device of a facility, the non-transitory computer program product containing instructions inscribed thereon which, when executed by one or more processors, cause the one or more processors to execute operations of any of the at least one controller disclosed above.
- the one or more processors are operatively coupled to the trunk line cable.
- at least two of the operation are executed by the same processor of the one or more processors.
- at least two of the operation are executed by different processors of the one or more processors.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non- transitory computer readable medium.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable media.
- a system for controlling at least one device of a facility comprising structural components of any of the structures (e.g., apparatuses) disclosed above.
- a system for power and communication transmission comprises: a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication; a branch line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device; and a distribution junction having a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which junction is configured to: (a) couple along the trunk line cable by the first connection and by the second connection, (b) couple to the branch line by the third connection, (c) direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (d) direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (e) direct the electrical current from the trunk line cable to the branch line cable, and (f) direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type from the trunk line cable to
- a non-transitory computer readable program product for controlling at least one device of a facility having instructions that, when read by at least one processor, cause the at least one processor to execute operations comprises: (A) transmitting, or directing transmission, through a cabling system an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, which cable is part of a cabling system to which the at least one device is operatively coupled, which cabling system comprises: a trunk line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a branch line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device, and a distribution junction having a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which junction configured to: (a)
- the one or more processors are operatively coupled to the trunk line cable. In some embodiments, at least two of the operation are executed by the same processor of the one or more processors. In some embodiments, at least two of the operation are executed by different processors of the one or more processors.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non- transitory computer readable medium. In some embodiments, the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable media.
- a method for controlling at least one device of a facility comprises: (A) transmitting through a cabling system an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, which cable is part of a cabling system to which the at least one device is operatively coupled, which cabling system comprises: a trunk line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a branch line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device, and a distribution junction having a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which junction configured to: (a) couple along the trunk line cable by the first connection and by the second connection, (b) couple to the branch line by the third connection, (c) direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the first connection
- a system for power and communication transmission comprises: a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of devices of a facility, and a second communication type configured for media communication; a plurality of branch line cables configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which plurality of branch line cables are configured to couple to the devices; and at least controller that is configured to control distribution of the electrical current and/or activation of the devices by considering the electrical current transmitted in the system.
- a n apparatus for controlling devices of a facility comprises at least one controller having a circuitry, which at least one controller is configured to: (A) operatively couple to a cabling system comprising: a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the devices, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a plurality of branch line cables configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which a plurality of branch line cables are configured to couple to the devices; (B) operatively couple to the devices; and (C) control, or direct control of, distribution of the electrical current and/or activation of the devices by considering the electrical current transmitted in the system.
- a cabling system comprising: a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the devices, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a plurality of branch line cables configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (
- the at least one controller comprises circuitry. In some embodiments, at least two of (A) to (C) are performed by the same controller of the at least one controller. In some embodiments, at least two of (A) to (C) are performed by different controllers of the at least one controller.
- a non-transitory computer readable program product for controlling devices of a facility having instructions that, when read by at least one processor, cause the at least one processor to execute operations comprises: (A) transmitting, or directing transmission, through a cabling system an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the devices, and a second communication type configured for media communication, which cable is part of a cabling system to which the devices are operatively coupled, which cabling system comprises: a trunk line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the devices, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a plurality of trunk line cables configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the devices; and (B) controlling, or directing control of, distribution of the electrical current and/or activation of the devices by considering the electrical current transmitted in the system.
- the one or more processors are operatively coupled to the cabling system.
- the operations (A) and (B) are executed by the same processor of the one or more processors.
- the operations are executed by different processors of the one or more processors.
- operation (A) is executed a processor different that the processor executing operation (B), which processor and different processor are of the one or more processors.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non- transitory computer readable medium.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable media.
- a method for controlling at least one device of a facility comprises: (A) transmitting through a cabling system an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, which cable is part of a cabling system to which the at least one device is operatively coupled, which cabling system comprises: a trunk line cable configured to transmit the electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of the devices, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a plurality of trunk line cables configured to transmit the electrical current, and (i) the first communication type, and/or (ii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the devices; and (B) controlling distribution of the electrical current and/or activation of the devices by considering the electrical current transmitted in the system.
- a system for controlling at least one device of a facility comprises a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, a branch line cable configured to (i) transmit the electrical current, (ii) the first communication type, and/or (iii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device; a distribution junction having a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which distribution junction is configured to: (a) couple along the trunk line cable by the first connection and by the second connection, (b) couple to the branch line by the third connection, (c) direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (d) direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (e) direct the electrical current from the trunk line cable to the branch line cable, and (f) direct the first communication type and/or the second
- the distribution junction is configured to facilitate bidirectional communication. In some embodiments, the distribution junction is configured to direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the second connection to the first connection. In some embodiments, directing the electrical current, the first communication type and/or the second communication type, is passive. In some embodiments, directing the electrical current, the first communication type and/or the second communication type is (i) active, (ii) dynamic, or (iii) active and dynamic. In some embodiments, directing the electrical current, the first communication type and/or the second communication type is facilitated by at least one controller. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is disposed in the distribution junction. In some embodiments, the at least one controller comprises a microcontroller.
- the distribution junction is configured to direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type along the trunk line cable from the second connection to the first connection. In some embodiments, the distribution junction is configured to direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type from the branch line cable to the trunk line cable. In some embodiments, the distribution junction is configured to connect to the at least one device through the trunk line.
- a method of controlling at least one device of a facility comprises: (A) using a cabling system comprising: (I) a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication, (II) a branch line cable configured to (i) transmit the electrical current, (ii) the first communication type, and/or (iii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device, and (III) a distribution junction having a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which distribution junction is configured to: (a) couple along the trunk line cable by the first connection and by the second connection, (b) couple to the branch line by the third connection, (c) direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (d) direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (e) direct the electrical current from
- the method further comprises providing and/or using the distribution junction that facilitates bidirectional communication. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the distribution junction to direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the second connection to the first connection. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the distribution junction to direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type along the trunk line cable from the second connection to the first connection. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the distribution junction to direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type from the branch line cable to the trunk line cable. In some embodiments, the method further comprises providing and/or using the distribution junction to connect to the at least one device through the trunk line.
- the distribution junction is configured to passively direct the electrical current, the first communication type and/or the second communication type. In some embodiments, the distribution junction is configured to actively and/or dynamically direct the electrical current, the first communication type and/or the second communication type. In some embodiments, directing the electrical current, the first communication type and/or the second communication type by the distribution junction is facilitated by at least one controller. In some embodiments, the at least one controller is disposed in the distribution junction. In some embodiments, the at least one controller comprises a microcontroller.
- an apparatus for controlling at least one device of a facility comprises at least one controller configured to: (A) operatively couple to a cabling system comprising: a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication; a branch line cable configured to (i) transmit the electrical current, (ii) the first communication type, and/or (iii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device; a distribution junction having a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which distribution junction is configured to: (a) couple along the trunk line cable by the first connection and by the second connection, (b) couple to the branch line by the third connection, (c) direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (d) direct the first communication type and/or the second communication type along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection, (e) direct the electrical current from the trunk
- the at least one controller comprises circuitry. In some embodiments, at least two of (A) to (C) are performed by the same controller of the at least one controller. In some embodiments, at least two of (A) to (C) are performed by different controllers of the at least one controller.
- a non-transitory computer readable program product for controlling at least one device of a facility, the non-transitory computer program product contains instructions inscribed thereon which, when executed by one or more processors operatively coupled to a cabling system of the facility, cause the one or more processors to execute operations, which cabling system comprises: a trunk line cable configured to transmit an electrical current, a first communication type utilized for control of at least one device, and a second communication type configured for media communication; a branch line cable configured to (i) transmit the electrical current, (ii) the first communication type, and/or (iii) the second communication type, which branch line is configured to couple to the at least one device; a distribution junction having a first connection, a second connection, and a third connection, which distribution junction is configured to: (a) couple along the trunk line cable by the first connection and by the second connection, (b) couple to the branch line by the third connection, (c) direct the electrical current along the trunk line cable from the first connection to the second connection
- the one or more processors are operatively coupled to the cabling system.
- the operations are executed by the same processor of the one or more processors.
- the operations are executed by different processors of the one or more processors.
- the non- transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable medium.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable media.
- a method of controlling at least one device of a facility comprises: (a) directing transmission of an electrical current from a trunk line cable to a device through a branch line cable operatively coupled to the trunk line cable through a distribution junction configured to direct an electrical current from the trunk line cable to the branch line cable; (b) monitoring an electrical power (e.g., electrical current) consumption of the device over the trunk line cable, the distribution junction, and the branch line cable; and (c) controlling the electrical current from the trunk line cable to the device in response to the monitoring.
- an electrical power e.g., electrical current
- the facility comprises a building. In some embodiments, the facility is a commercial facility. In some embodiments, the facility is a residential facility. In some embodiments, the residential facility comprises a single family house. In some embodiments, the residential facility comprises a multi-family house. In some embodiments, the distribution junction is configured to direct a communication from the trunk line cable to the branch line cable. In some embodiments, the communication comprises a first communication type and a second communication type. In some embodiments, the first communication type utilizes wavelengths different from wavelengths utilized by the second communication type. In some embodiments, the communication comprises media communication. In some embodiments, the communication comprises cellular communication.
- the cellular communication conforms to at least (i) a fourth generation, (ii) a fifth generation, or (iii) a fourth generation and a fifth generation, cellular communication protocol.
- the communication comprises data transfer.
- the communication adheres to a control protocol.
- the method further comprises controlling the communication from the trunk line cable to the device in response to the monitoring.
- the method further comprises providing and/or using the at least one device as a sensor, an emitter, or a combination thereof.
- the method further comprises providing and/or using the at least one device as an antenna.
- an apparatus for controlling at least one device of a facility comprising at least one controller configured to operatively couple to the cabling system and perform, or direct performance of, any operation of any of the methods disclosed above.
- the at least one controller comprises circuitry.
- at least two of the operations are performed by the same controller of the at least one controller.
- at least two of the operations are performed by different controllers of the at least one controller.
- a non-transitory computer readable program product for controlling at least one device of a facility, the non-transitory computer program product containing instructions inscribed thereon which, when executed by one or more processors operatively coupled to the cabling system, cause the one or more processors to execute any operation of the methods disclosed above.
- the one or more processors are operatively coupled to the cabling system.
- the operations are executed by the same processor of the one or more processors.
- the operations are executed by different processors of the one or more processors.
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable medium.
- the non- transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable media.
- a system for controlling at least one device of a facility comprising structural components of any of the structures (e.g., apparatuses) disclosed above.
- an electrical power e.g., electrical current
- the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises one or more media. In some embodiments, the operations are executed by the same processor of the one or more processors. In some embodiments, the operations are executed by different processors of the one or more processors. In some embodiments, the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable medium. In some embodiments, the non-transitory computer readable program product comprises a non-transitory computer readable media.
- an apparatus for controlling at least one device of a facility comprises at least one controller configured to: (a) operatively couple to a cabling system of the facility and to an electrical power source of an electrical current; (b) direct transmission of the electrical current from a trunk line cable of the cabling system to a device of the facility through a branch line cable operatively coupled to the trunk line cable through a distribution junction configured to direct an electrical current from the trunk line cable to the branch line cable; (c) monitor, or direct monitoring of, an electrical power consumption of the device over the trunk line cable, the distribution junction, and the branch line cable; and (d) control, or direct control of, the electrical current from the trunk line cable to the device in response to the monitoring.
- the at least one controller comprises circuitry. In some embodiments, at least two of (b) to (d) are performed by the same controller of the at least one controller. In some embodiments, at least two of (b) to (d) are performed by different controllers of the at least one controller.
- a control panel configured to provide network services to end targets (e.g., devices) in a facility (e.g., building).
- the end targets (e.g. devices) may be coupled together by a network including at least one coaxial cable.
- the control panel can include a coaxial cable connector configured to couple to the at least one coaxial cable.
- the control panel may include a direct-current (DC) electrical power source, a data networking head-end, and/or cellular communications head-end.
- DC direct-current
- the DC power source is(i) coupled to the coaxial cable connector and (ii) configured to provide a DC signal to at least a portion of the at least one coaxial cable.
- the data networking head-end is (i) coupled to the coaxial cable connector and (ii) configured to communicate with (e.g., using a communications protocol and/or over the at least one coaxial cable) at least a first subset of the end targets (e.g., devices) in the enclosure (e.g., building).
- the cellular communications head-end is coupled to the coaxial cable connector.
- the cellular communications head-end is coupled to at least a second subset of the end targets (e.g., devices) in the enclosure (e.g., building) through the at least one coaxial cable.
- the cellular communications head-end is configured to provide first cellular communications to the coaxial cable connector for transmission through the second subset of the end targets (e.g., devices).
- the cellular communications head-end is configured to receive second cellular communications from the coaxial cable connector upon receipt of the second cellular communications by the second subset of the end targets (e.g., devices).
- a control panel that also includes a plurality of optical fiber connectors, where the control panel is configured to communicate with additional control panels through optical fibers coupled to the optical fiber connectors.
- Certain implementations may include an apparatus for controlling one or more optically-switchable windows, the apparatus including a first connector, the first connector configured to couple to a first network cable; a low-pass filter coupled to the first connector; DC-to-DC circuitry coupled to the low-pass filter, configured to receive a DC signal from the first network cable through the low-pass filter, and configured to convert the DC signal into one or more regulated DC signals; a second connector, the second connector configured to provide a first regulated DC signal from the DC-to-DC circuitry to a second network cable; one or more controllers, where the one or more controllers are collectively configured to (1) receive and be powered by one of the regulated DC signals from the DC-to-DC circuitry and (2) provide bidirectional communications between a first external device and a second external device, the first external device being coupled to the one or more controllers via the first connector and the second external device being coupled to the one or more controllers via the second connector; a third connector, the third connector configured to couple to the one or more one optical
- Certain implementations may include one or more of the following features.
- An apparatus in which the one or more controllers include a G.hn interface coupled to the first connector, the G.hn interface being configured to provide bidirectional communications in a G.hn communications protocol between the first external device and the apparatus.
- An apparatus in which the one or more controllers include an Ethernet interface coupled to the second connector, the Ethernet interface being configured to provide bidirectional communications in an Ethernet protocol between the second external device and the apparatus.
- MoCA multimedia over coax alliance
- An apparatus in which the low-pass filter includes an inductor choke.
- An apparatus in which the DC-to-DC circuitry includes at least one of a buck converter and a boost converter.
- the network adapter includes a first connector, the first connector configured to couple to a first network cable; a low-pass filter coupled to the first connector; DC-to-DC circuitry coupled to the low-pass filter, configured to receive a DC signal from the first network cable through the low-pass filter, and configured to convert the DC signal into one or more regulated DC signals; a second connector, the second connector configured to provide one of the regulated DC signals from the DC-to-DC circuitry to a second network cable; and one or more controllers, wherein the one or more controllers are collectively configured to: (1) receive and be electrically powered by one of the regulated DC signals from the DC-to-DC circuitry, (2) bi directionally communicate, using a first communications protocol, with a first external device, the first external device coupled to the one or more controllers via the first connector, (3)
- Certain implementations may include one or more of the following features.
- a network adapter in which the one or more controllers include a G.hn interface coupled to the first connector and in which the first communications protocol is a G.hn communications protocol.
- a network adapter in which the one or more controllers include a multimedia over coax alliance (MoCA) interface coupled to the first connector and in which the first communications protocol is a MoCA communications protocol.
- a network adapter in which the one or more controllers include an Ethernet interface coupled to the second connector and in which the second communications protocol is an Ethernet communications protocol.
- a network adapter in which the first connector is a coaxial cable connector and in which the second connector is a power-over- Ethernet connector.
- a network adapter in which the one of the regulated DC signals provided by the second connector is a 48 volt DC signal compliant with a power-over- Ethernet protocol.
- Certain implementations may include a system.
- the system includes a control panel configured to generate a DC signal; a plurality of distribution junctions; a first coaxial cable trunk line; and a plurality of additional coaxial cable trunk lines, where the first coaxial cable trunk line is coupled between the control panel and a first one of the distribution junctions, where the additional coaxial cable trunk lines are coupled between respective pairs of the distribution junctions, where the distribution junctions, the first coaxial cable trunk line, and the additional coaxial cable trunk lines are collectively configured to (i) convey the DC signal from the control panel to each of the distribution junctions, (ii) bidirectionally convey first time-varying signals formatted in a first digital communications protocol between the control panel and each of the distribution junctions, and (iii) bidirectionally convey second time- varying signals formatted in a second digital communications protocol between the control panel and at least
- each distribution junction includes: an unbalanced transformer having a primary circuit, a secondary circuit, and a tertiary circuit, where the primary circuit is coupled to an upstream coaxial cable trunk line, where the secondary circuit is coupled to a downstream coaxial cable trunk line, where the tertiary circuit is coupled to a coaxial cable branch line specific to that distribution junction, and where a first time-varying signal that has a first (e.g., communication signal such as RF) power level and that is received by the primary circuit is divided unequally onto the second and tertiary circuits such that the second circuit receives the first time-varying signal at a second (e.g., communication signal such as RF) power level that is at least 75% of the first power level and that the tertiary circuit receives the first time-varying signal at a third (e.g., communication signal such as RF) power level that is no more than 25% of the first power level.
- a first time-varying signal that has a first (e.g., communication signal
- each distribution junction includes: an unbalanced transformer having a primary circuit, a secondary circuit, and a tertiary circuit, where the primary circuit is coupled to an upstream coaxial cable trunk line, where the secondary circuit is coupled to a downstream coaxial cable trunk line, where the tertiary circuit is coupled to a coaxial cable branch line specific to that distribution junction, and where a first time-varying signal that has a first power level and that is received by the primary circuit is divided unequally onto the second and tertiary circuits such that the second circuit receives the first time-varying signal at a second power level, the tertiary circuit receives the first time-varying signal at a third power level, and the third power level is less than the second power level.
- a system in which at least some of the distribution junctions further include a first inductor coupling the DC signal from the upstream coaxial cable trunk line to the downstream coaxial cable trunk line associated with that distribution junction and a second inductor coupling the DC signal from the upstream coaxial cable trunk line to the coaxial cable brane line associated with that distribution junction.
- the second time-varying signals are cellular communications signals and in which the first one of the distribution junctions includes a branch circuit including a passive cellular antenna.
- the present disclosure provides methods that use any of the systems and/or apparatuses disclosed herein, e.g., for their intended purpose.
- an apparatus comprises at least one controller that is programmed to direct a mechanism used to implement (e.g., effectuate) any of the method disclosed herein, wherein the at least one controller is operatively coupled to the mechanism.
- an apparatus comprises at least one controller that is configured (e.g., programmed) to implement (e.g., effectuate) the method disclosed herein.
- the at least one controller may implement any of the methods disclosed herein.
- a system comprises at least one controller that is programmed to direct operation of at least one another apparatus (or component thereof), and the apparatus (or component thereof), wherein the at least one controller is operatively coupled to the apparatus (or to the component thereof).
- the apparatus (or component thereof) may include any apparatus (or component thereof) disclosed herein.
- the at least one controller may direct any apparatus (or component thereof) disclosed herein.
- a computer software product comprising a non-transitory computer-readable medium in which program instructions are stored, which instructions, when read by a computer, cause the computer to direct a mechanism disclosed herein to implement (e.g., effectuate) any of the method disclosed herein, wherein the non-transitory computer-readable medium is operatively coupled to the mechanism.
- the mechanism can comprise any apparatus (or any component thereof) disclosed herein.
- the present disclosure provides a non-transitory computer- readable medium comprising machine-executable code that, upon execution by one or more computer processors, implements any of the methods disclosed herein.
- the present disclosure provides a non-transitory computer- readable medium comprising machine-executable code that, upon execution by one or more computer processors, effectuates directions of the controller(s) (e.g., as disclosed herein).
- the present disclosure provides a computer system comprising one or more computer processors and a non-transitory computer-readable medium coupled thereto.
- the non-transitory computer-readable medium comprises machine-executable code that, upon execution by the one or more computer processors, implements any of the methods disclosed herein and/or effectuates directions of the controller(s) disclosed herein.
- FIG. 1 schematically depicts a control system architecture and perspective view of an enclosure
- FIG. 2 schematically depicts a network infrastructure
- FIG. 3 schematically depicts an electrical circuit and shows a distribution junction housing
- FIG. 4 schematically depicts a network cable
- FIG. 5 schematically depicts signals at different frequencies
- FIG. 6 schematically depicts a network adapter
- FIG. 7 schematically depicts a control panel
- FIG. 8 schematically depicts a network infrastructure
- FIG. 9 schematically depicts a network infrastructure
- FIG. 10 schematically depicts a network infrastructure
- FIG. 11 A, 11 B, and 11 C schematically depicts network infrastructures
- Fig. 12 schematically depicts a cross-sectional view of an electrochromic device
- Fig. 13 schematically depicts a cross-sectional side view of a tintable window
- FIG. 14 schematically depicts a computer system
- FIG. 15 schematically depicts various facility floor network topologies.
- FIG. 16A schematically depicts a facility floor network topology
- Fig. 16B depicts a view of a portion of the facility floor network
- FIGs. 17A-B schematically depicts various facility floor network topologies
- FIG. 18 schematically depicts a facility floor network topology
- Fig. 19 schematically depicts an electronic schematics of a distribution junction
- Fig. 20 schematically depicts various mechanical configurations related to distribution junctions
- Fig. 21 schematically depicts various mechanical configurations related to distribution junctions
- Fig. 22 schematically depicts an electronic schematic of a distribution junction
- Fig. 23 schematically depicts various network infrastructures
- Fig. 24 depicts a flowchart of an illustrative method of utilizing a distribution junction
- Fig. 25 depicts a flowchart depicting an illustrative method of managing a device
- Fig. 26 depicts a flowchart depicting an illustrative method of prioritizing a power budget for a device
- Fig. 27 depicts a flowchart depicting an illustrative method of managing power distribution for a device
- Fig. 28 depicts a flowchart depicting an illustrative method of managing devices in the context of tintable windows.
- ranges are meant to be inclusive, unless otherwise specified.
- a range between value 1 and value 2 is meant to be inclusive and include value 1 and value 2.
- the inclusive range will span any value from about value 1 to about value 2.
- the term “adjacent” or “adjacent to,” as used herein, includes “next to,” “adjoining,” “in contact with,” and “in proximity to.”
- the conjunction “and/or” in a phrase such as “including X, Y, and/or Z”, refers to in inclusion of any combination or plurality of X, Y, and Z.
- such phrase is meant to include X.
- such phrase is meant to include Y.
- such phrase is meant to include Z.
- such phrase is meant to include X and Y.
- such phrase is meant to include X and Z.
- such phrase is meant to include Y and Z.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Xs.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Ys.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Zs.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Xs and a plurality of Ys.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Xs and a plurality of Zs.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Ys and a plurality of Zs.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Xs and Y.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Xs and Z.
- such phrase is meant to include a plurality of Ys and Z.
- such phrase is meant to include X and a plurality of Ys.
- such phrase is meant to include X and a plurality of Zs.
- such phrase is meant to include Y and a plurality of Zs.
- the conjunction “and/or” is meant to have the same effect as the phrase “X, Y, Z, or any combination or plurality thereof.”
- the conjunction “and/or” is meant to have the same effect as the phrase “one or more X, Y, Z, or any combination thereof.”
- the conjunction “and/or” is meant to have the same effect as the phrase “at least one X, Y, Z, or any combination thereof.”
- the conjunction “and/or” is meant to have the same effect as the phrase at least one of: X, Y, and Z.”
- the term “operatively coupled” or “operatively connected” refers to a first element (e.g., mechanism) that is coupled (e.g., connected) to a second element, to allow the intended operation of the second and/or first element.
- the coupling may comprise physical or non-physical coupling.
- the non-physical coupling may comprise signal-induced coupling (e.g., wireless coupling). Coupled can include physical coupling (e.g., physically connected), or non-physical coupling (e.g., via wireless communication).
- An element that is “configured to” perform a function includes a structural feature that causes the element to perform this function.
- a structural feature may include an electrical feature, such as a circuitry or a circuit element.
- a structural feature may include a circuitry (e.g., comprising electrical or optical circuitry). Electrical circuitry may comprise one or more wires.
- Optical circuitry may comprise at least one optical element (e.g., beam splitter, mirror, lens and/or optical fiber).
- a structural feature may include a mechanical feature.
- a mechanical feature may comprise a latch, a spring, a closure, a hinge, a chassis, a support, a fastener, or a cantilever, and so forth.
- Performing the function may comprise utilizing a logical feature.
- a logical feature may include programming instructions. Programming instructions may be executable by at least one processor. Programming instructions may be stored or encoded on a medium accessible by one or more processors. Additionally, in the following description, the phrases “operable to,” “adapted to,” “configured to,” “designed to,” “programmed to,” or “capable of” may be used interchangeably where appropriate.
- Certain disclosed embodiments provide a network infrastructure in an enclosure (e.g., a facility such as a building).
- the network infrastructure is available for various purposes such as for providing communication and/or electrical power (e.g., electrical current) services.
- the communication services may comprise high bandwidth (e.g., wireless and/or wired) communications services.
- the communication services can be to occupants of a facility and/or users outside the facility (e.g., building).
- the network infrastructure may work in concert with, or as a partial replacement of, the infrastructure of one or more cellular carriers.
- the network infrastructure can be provided in a facility that includes tintable (e.g., electrically switchable) windows. Examples of components of the network infrastructure include a high speed backhaul.
- the network infrastructure may include at least one cable, switch, physical antenna, transceivers, sensor, transmitter, receiver, radio, processor or controller (that may comprise a processor).
- the network infrastructure may be operatively coupled to, and/or include, a wireless network.
- the network infrastructure may comprising wiring.
- the network infrastructure may comprise a wiring.
- the wiring may comprise a cable.
- the cable may include a jacket, insulation, an electrical wire, and/or an optical fiber.
- the cable may comprise a cable assembly.
- the cable may include at least one optical cable, coaxial cable, twisted pair, direct buried cable, flexible cable, filled cable, Heliax cable, non-metallic sheathed cable, metallic sheathed cable, multicore cable, paired cable, portable cord, ribbon cable, shielded cable, single cable, structured cabling, submersible cable, twinaxial (twinax) cable, twin and earth (T&E) cable, twin-lead, and/or twisted pair.
- the coaxial cable may have a characteristic impedance of, e.g., of at most about 50, or 75 ohms (e.g., LMR-400).
- the network infrastructure provides additional coverage.
- the additional coverage may be beyond the one provided by the cellular carrier.
- the additional coverage may be (i) in the interior of the building and/or (ii) in the exterior of the building.
- the network infrastructure may provide and/or supplement the cellular carrier's ability to provide coverage and any other capacity outside the building.
- the network infrastructure may provide and/or supplement cellular coverage near to the facility (e.g., building). Near the facility can be, e.g., at least about 10m, 50m, 100m, 500m, or 1000 meters (m) from an edge of the facility.
- Near the facility can be between any of the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 10m to about 1000m, from about 10m to about 500m, or from about 500m to about 1000m). Near the building may be within a line of site of the facility. In some cases, a facility and its associated network infrastructure can serve as a cellular tower.
- High speed and high frequency communications protocols face challenges before they can be widely accepted and deployed.
- high frequency bands may require more antennas.
- it is estimated that to deploy a 5G cellular service in a given area will require over twice as many antennas as are required to provide the same level of cellular service for fourth generation (4G) communication protocol.
- Some of those antennas may be provided in a facility or a portion of a facility.
- 5G coverage in an urban canyon such as a street in major metropolitan area such as Manhattan NY, or Singapore.
- 5G service may require many antennas to provide adequate coverage and adequate capacity in these cities.
- public space e.g., telephone poles
- a carrier could deploy additional antennas to provide adequate 5G coverage (and/or other cellular capacity).
- the private buildings that line an urban canyon can provide locations for 5G antennas.
- 5G and other high frequency protocols may be susceptible to attenuation.
- 5G communications (particularly at their high frequency bands such as in the range of from about 6 to about 30 GHz) can be susceptible to attenuation by conductive structures such as, e.g., reinforced concrete in walls, aluminum coated thermal insulation (e.g., in facility walls and floors), Low-E films on glass, and/or electrochromic devices on glass.
- active elements such as repeaters may be provided in a facility.
- cellular repeaters may be disposed on or proximate the walls, windows, floors, and/or ceilings that attenuate wireless signals.
- 5G When describing the cellular protocols disclosed herein, 5G is frequently used as an example. However, the disclosed embodiments pertain to any wireless communications protocol or combination of protocols.
- the communications infrastructure described herein may serve various functions, some of which are listed here.
- one or more systems and/or apparatuses described herein are configured to selectively attenuate (e.g., block) and/or transmit wireless signals, e.g., in a controllable manner.
- a system and/or apparatus is configured such that transmission of wireless communications is based at least in part on location, and/or time.
- a system, an apparatus, or any component thereof is configured such that it is at least partially automatically controlled (e.g., fully automatically controlled).
- One or more components of the system and/or apparatus described herein is fully automatically controlled. Controlled may include attenuated, modulated, varied, managed, curbed, disciplined, regulated, restrained, supervised, manipulated, and/or guided.
- control is accomplished by using controllable active elements that receive, analyze, manipulate (e.g., convert and/or compare) and/or retransmit signals.
- a receiving antenna may face in one direction on one side of a facility (e.g., of a wall or a window) and
- a transmitter antenna may face in another (e.g., opposite or substantially opposite) direction on the other side of facility (e.g., on another wall or window).
- the active element can include one or more transceivers and/or other signal converters.
- (I) when the active element is active e.g., “on”
- the element is inactive (e.g., “off”), it is not transmitting signal.
- an active element that receives and retransmits wireless communications signals is a repeater.
- the repeater may boost signal and/or transmit it to a location that would not otherwise receive the signals.
- a repeater (or other active element) may include a particular antenna combination.
- the antenna combination may include one type of antenna on the inside of the facility (e.g., building) and a different type of antenna on the outside of the facility (or on opposites of an internal wall or window).
- some embodiments employ a handle antenna on the outside the building operatively coupled to one of the other antennas (e.g., a microstrip antenna) on the inside of the building.
- one or both antennas are disposed on a mullion feature such as a beauty cap.
- the antenna may comprise an isotropic, dipole, monopole, array, loop, conical, aperture, traveling wave, or random wire antenna.
- the loop antenna may include large loops (e.g., Quad, or Halfloop), interbetween (e.g., Halo), and/or small loops (e.g., Ferrite) antenna.
- electrochromic windows may provide signal blocking in the range of from about 10dB to about 20 dB of insertion loss (e.g., depending on the transmission frequency). Greater loss may occur at higher frequencies.
- Some embodiments disclosed herein employ wireless re-transmitters and/or repeaters, to circumvent the signal blocking by electrochromic windows.
- such re-transmitters are disposed on or proximate to at least one Integrated Glass Unit (IGU).
- the IGU may comprise an electrochromic device (e.g., comprising a layers structure).
- a window and/or wall contains a layer or structure that substantially (e.g., fully) blocks wireless transmission, e.g., over a spectral range.
- the layer structure may be of an IGU.
- a blocking layer completely covers one surface of a lite (e.g., glass). Examples of blocking structures for windows are described in U.S. Patent Application Serial Number 15/709,339, filed September 19, 2017, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- Security systems may employ a facility structure that attenuates (e.g., depress) transmission of one or more electromagnetic signals, for example, in certain regions of the spectrum (e.g., in at least the 5G region).
- the facility structure may comprise a window, door, or wall.
- Security systems may employ a wall and/or window that substantially (e.g., effectively) block transmission of one or more electromagnetic signals, for example, in certain regions of the spectrum (e.g., in at least the 5G region).
- a signal repeater and/or re-transmitter need not retransmit the wireless signal (e.g., directly) across the facility structure (e.g., a wall or window). In some cases, it selectively transmits wireless signal through the facility to one or more locations remote from where the signal was received. It may carry the received signal using a wired network, e.g., by running a communication protocol such as Ethernet. For example, an externally generated wireless signal can be received on sensor disposed on a roof of a building (or on any other exterior wall) and, from there, transmitted over wires to one or more distant locations within the facility (such as ten floors below the roof, e.g., to the basement).
- a re-transmitting system transmits cellular signals (or other appropriate wireless signals) to selected building locations at one or more selected times, which may be delayed from the time at which a wireless signal was initially received.
- the communications may be stored or have its transmission delayed.
- the re-transmission may be done independently of where and when communications embodied in the cellular signals are received.
- 5G antennas may supplement the data carrying and antenna infrastructure of a cellular network of a carrier.
- such antennas are connected to high bandwidth network infrastructures such as the Ethernet network infrastructure within the buildings.
- An example fully or partially wired network infrastructure for supporting such 5G applications is described in U.S. Provisional Patent Application Serial Number 62/803,324, filed February 8, 2019, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- Various arrangements of antennas may be deployed to support 5G cellular and/or other communications services. Both coverage and capacity can be considered when designing the wireless communication infrastructure. Coverage can be addressed by providing various antennas strategically located (e.g., attached to, or as part of, a facility) to provide cellular service to a defined area. Capacity may be addressed by having high- bandwidth data carrying lines and/or switches. Some examples of high capacity infrastructure are provided in U.S. Provisional Patent Application Serial Number 62/803,324, filed February 8, 2019, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety. Capacity may also be addressed by providing a plurality of antennas, e.g., within a defined region. [0121] In certain embodiments, individual antennas are dedicated to particular protocols. At least one of the antennas (e.g., each of the antennas) may have its own base band radio.
- one or more antennas may be designed for use with low power citizens broadband radio (CBRS), e.g., including a CBRS base band radio.
- CBRS citizens broadband radio
- CBRS is about 150 MHz wide broadcast band of the about 3.5 GHz band (e.g., from about 3550 MHz to about 3700 MHz), that may be used to provide wireless services unlicensed by the United States Federal Communications Commission.
- Other antennas and associated base band radios may be provided for cellular communications, e.g., according with a particular protocol and/or jurisdictional restrictions (e.g., rules and/or regulations).
- the required base band radios may be installed at one or more locations of a facility, including, e.g., in digital architectural elements.
- Digital architecture may refer to aspects of architecture that feature one or more digital technologies.
- Various embodiments support multiple frequency bands and/or multiple protocols. Examples include cellular (3G, 4G, and/or 5G, etc.). Examples include local area networking of devices and/or Internet access. Examples include wireless networks including WLANs (e.g., WiFi) and/or associated applications such as voice over WLAN. Examples include Citizens Broadband Radio Service (CBRS).
- a given antenna (or combination of antennas) can be is protocol independent.
- the associated transmitters and/or receivers can be protocol independent. For example, carrier A and carrier B may use different radios (e.g., different channels utilizing Multimedia over Coaxial Alliance standard (MoCA) for networking over coaxial cable). Similar antenna structures may be used to send and/or receive signals for a plurality of protocols.
- MoCA Multimedia over Coaxial Alliance standard
- 5G network may have an Enhanced Mobile Broadband (eMBB), Ultra Reliable Low Latency Communications (URLLC), and/or Massive Machine Type Communications (mMTC).
- Enhanced Mobile Broadband (eMBB) may use 5G as a progression from 4G LTE mobile broadband services.
- 5G network may exhibit faster connections, higher throughput, and/or more capacity as compared to 4G network.
- Ultra-Reliable Low-Latency Communications (URLLC) may refer to using the network for applications requiring uninterrupted and/or robust data exchange.
- Massive Machine-Type Communications (mMTC) can be used to connect to a large number of low electrical power (e.g., electrical current), low cost devices, which have high scalability and/or increased battery lifetime, e.g., in a wide area.
- a 5G network will transmit at least about 1Gbit of data per second (Gbit/s), 2 Gbit/s, 3 Gbit/s, or 5 Gbit/s.
- the 5G air latency target is at least about 1 millisecond (ms), 2ms, 3ms, 4ms, 5ms, 8ms, 10ms, 11ms, 15ms, or 30ms.
- the 5G air latency target can be at most about 2ms, 3ms, 4ms, 5ms, 8ms,
- the 5G air latency target can be of any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 1 to about 4ms, from about 3ms to about 10ms, from about 8ms to about 12ms, or from about 12 ms to about 40ms).
- certain infrastructures contain devices for interior (e.g., within a building) communications via a 5G protocol, e.g., without supporting Wi-Fi.
- a 5G protocol e.g., without supporting Wi-Fi.
- 5G antennas may be deployed throughout a building (e.g., when 5G may be limited to a line of sight). The antennas may be disposed at one or more locations where Wi-Fi antennas normally reside. In some installations, 5G will have sufficient bandwidth and/or coverage to serve one or more of (e.g., all) the functions that Wi-Fi currently serves.
- an enclosure comprises an area defined by at least one structure.
- the at least one structure may comprise at least one wall.
- An enclosure may comprise and/or enclose one or more sub-enclosure.
- the at least one wall may comprise metal (e.g., steel), clay, stone, plastic, glass, plaster (e.g., gypsum), polymer (e.g., polyurethane, styrene, or vinyl), asbestos, fiber-glass, concrete (e.g., reinforced concrete), wood, paper, or a ceramic.
- the at least one wall may comprise wire, bricks, blocks (e.g., cinder blocks), tile, drywall, or frame (e.g., steel frame).
- the enclosure comprises one or more openings.
- the one or more openings may be reversibly closable.
- the one or more openings may be permanently open.
- a fundamental length scale of the one or more openings may be smaller relative to the fundamental length scale of the wall(s) that define the enclosure.
- a fundamental length scale may comprise a diameter of a bounding circle, a length, a width, or a height.
- a surface of the one or more openings may be smaller relative to the surface the wall(s) that define the enclosure.
- the opening surface may be a percentage of the total surface of the wall(s). For example, the opening surface can measure about 30%, 20%, 10%, 5%, or 1% of the walls(s).
- the wall(s) may comprise a floor, a ceiling or a side wall.
- the closable opening may be closed by at least one window or door.
- the enclosure may be at least a portion of a facility.
- the enclosure may comprise at least a portion of a building.
- the building may be a private building and/or a commercial building.
- the building may comprise one or more floors.
- the building (e.g., floor thereof) may include at least one of: a room, hall, foyer, attic, basement, balcony (e.g., inner or outer balcony), stairwell, corridor, elevator shaft, fagade, mezzanine, penthouse, garage, porch (e.g., enclosed porch), terrace (e.g., enclosed terrace), cafeteria, and/or Duct.
- an enclosure may be stationary and/or movable (e.g., a train, a plane, a ship, a vehicle, or a rocket).
- the facility may include one or more enclosures.
- the facility may be stationary or mobile.
- the facility may comprise a transitory vehicle such as a car, RV, buss, train, airplane, helicopter, ship, or boat.
- the facility may include one or more buildings.
- the enclosure encloses an atmosphere.
- the atmosphere may comprise one or more gases.
- the gases may include inert gases (e.g., argon or nitrogen) and/or non-inert gases (e.g., oxygen or carbon dioxide).
- the enclosure atmosphere may resemble an atmosphere external to the enclosure (e.g., ambient atmosphere) in at least one external atmosphere characteristic that includes: temperature, relative gas content, gas type (e.g., humidity, and/or oxygen level), debris (e.g., dust and/or pollen), and/or gas velocity.
- the enclosure atmosphere may be different from the atmosphere external to the enclosure in at least one external atmosphere characteristic that includes: temperature, relative gas content, gas type (e.g., humidity, and/or oxygen level), debris (e.g., dust and/or pollen), and/or gas velocity.
- the enclosure atmosphere may be less humid (e.g., drier) than the external (e.g., ambient) atmosphere.
- the enclosure atmosphere may contain the same (e.g., or a substantially similar) oxygen-to-nitrogen ratio as the atmosphere external to the enclosure.
- the velocity of the gas in the enclosure may be (e.g., substantially) similar throughout the enclosure.
- the velocity of the gas in the enclosure may be different in different portions of the enclosure (e.g., by flowing gas through to a vent that is coupled with the enclosure).
- Certain disclosed embodiments provide a network infrastructure in the enclosure (e.g., a facility such as a building).
- the network infrastructure is available for various purposes such as for providing communication and/or electrical power services.
- the communication services may comprise high bandwidth (e.g., wireless and/or wired) communications services.
- the communication services can be to occupants of a facility and/or users outside the facility (e.g., building).
- the network infrastructure may work in concert with, or as a partial replacement of, the infrastructure of one or more cellular carriers.
- the network infrastructure can be provided in a facility that includes electrically switchable windows. Examples of components of the network infrastructure include a high speed backhaul.
- the network infrastructure may include at least one cable, switch, physical antenna, transceivers, sensor, transmitter, receiver, radio, processor and/or controller (that may comprise a processor).
- the network infrastructure may be operatively coupled to, and/or include, a wireless network.
- the network infrastructure may comprise wiring.
- One or more sensors can be deployed (e.g., installed) in an environment as part of installing the network and/or after installing the network.
- a network infrastructure supports a control system for one or more windows such as electrochromic (e.g., tintable) windows.
- the control system may comprise one or more controllers operatively coupled (e.g., directly or indirectly) to one or more windows.
- electrochromic windows also referred to herein as “optically switchable windows,” “tintable windows”, or “smart windows”
- the concepts disclosed herein may apply to other types of switchable optical devices including, for example, a liquid crystal device, or a suspended particle device (SPD), NanoChromics display (NCD), Organic electroluminescent display (OELD), suspended particle device (SPD), NanoChromics display (NCD), or an Organic electroluminescent display (OELD).
- the display element may be attached to a part of a transparent body (such as the windows).
- a liquid crystal device and/or a suspended particle device may be implemented instead of, or in addition to, an electrochromic device.
- the tintable window may be disposed in a (non-transitory) facility such as a building, and/or in any other enclosure such as in a transitory vehicle such as a car, RV, buss, train, airplane, helicopter, ship, or boat.
- a tintable window exhibits a (e.g., controllable and/or reversible) change in at least one optical property of the window, e.g., when a stimulus is applied.
- the stimulus can include an optical, electrical and/or magnetic stimulus.
- the stimulus can include an applied voltage.
- One or more tintable windows can be used to control lighting and/or glare conditions, e.g., by regulating the transmission of solar energy propagating through them.
- One or more tintable windows can be used to control a temperature within an enclosure (e.g., building), e.g., by regulating the transmission of solar energy propagating through them.
- Control of the solar energy may control heat load imposed on the interior of the enclosure (e.g., a facility such as a building).
- the control may be manual and/or automatic.
- the control may be used for maintaining one or more requested (e.g., environmental) conditions, e.g., occupant comfort.
- the control may include reducing energy consumption of a heating, ventilation, air conditioning and/or lighting systems. At least two of heating, ventilation, and air conditioning may be induced by separate systems.
- At least two of heating, ventilation, and air conditioning may be induced by one system.
- the heating, ventilation, and air conditioning may be induced by a single system (abbreviated herein as “HVAC).
- tintable windows may be responsive to (e.g., and communicatively coupled to) one or more environmental sensors and/or user control.
- Tintable windows may comprise (e.g., may be) electrochromic windows.
- the windows may be located in the range from the interior to the exterior of an enclosure structure (e.g., facility such as a building). However, this need not be the case.
- Tintable windows may operate using liquid crystal devices, suspended particle devices, microelectromechanical systems (MEMS) devices (such as microshutters), or any technology known now, or later developed, that is configured to control light transmission through a window.
- MEMS microelectromechanical systems
- tintable windows can be located within the interior of an enclosure (e.g., building), e.g., between a conference room and a hallway.
- an enclosure e.g., building
- one or more tintable windows can be used in automobiles, trains, aircraft, and other vehicles, e.g., in lieu of a passive and/or non-tinting window.
- the tintable window comprises an electrochromic device (referred to herein as an “EC device” (abbreviated herein as ECD), or “EC”).
- An EC device may comprise at least one coating that includes at least one layer.
- the at least one layer can comprise an electrochromic material.
- the electrochromic material exhibits a change from one optical state to another, e.g., when an electric potential is applied across the EC device.
- the transition of the electrochromic layer from one optical state to another optical state can be caused, e.g., by reversible, semi-reversible, or irreversible ion insertion into the electrochromic material (e.g., by way of intercalation) and a corresponding injection of charge-balancing electrons.
- the transition of the electrochromic layer from one optical state to another optical state can be caused, e.g., by a reversible ion insertion into the electrochromic material (e.g., by way of intercalation) and a corresponding injection of charge-balancing electrons.
- Reversible may be for the expected lifetime of the ECD.
- Semi-reversible refers to a measurable (e.g.
- a fraction of the ions responsible for the optical transition is irreversibly bound up in the electrochromic material (e.g., and thus the induced (altered) tint state of the window is not reversible to its original tinting state).
- at least some (e.g., all) of the irreversibly bound ions can be used to compensate for “blind charge” in the material (e.g., ECD).
- suitable ions include cations.
- the cations may include lithium ions (Li+) and/or hydrogen ions (H+) (i.e., protons).
- other ions can be suitable.
- Intercalation of the cations may be into an (e.g., metal) oxide.
- a change in the intercalation state of the ions (e.g. cations) into the oxide may induce a visible change in a tint (e.g., color) of the oxide.
- the oxide may transition from a colorless to a colored state.
- intercalation of lithium ions into tungsten oxide may cause the tungsten oxide to change from a transparent state to a colored (e.g., blue) state.
- EC device coatings as described herein are located within the viewable portion of the tintable window such that the tinting of the EC device coating can be used to control the optical state of the tintable window.
- an enclosure includes one or more sensors.
- the sensor may facilitate controlling the environment of the enclosure such that inhabitants of the enclosure may have an environment that is more comfortable, peaceful, beautiful, healthy, productive (e.g., in terms of inhabitant performance), easer to live (e.g., work) in, or any combination thereof.
- the sensor(s) may be configured as low or high resolution sensors. Sensor may provide on/off indications of the occurrence and/or presence of a particular environmental event (e.g., one pixel sensors).
- the accuracy and/or resolution of a sensor may be improved via artificial intelligence analysis of its measurements. Examples of artificial intelligence techniques that may be used include: reactive, limited memory, theory of mind, and/or self-aware techniques know to those skilled in the art).
- Sensors may be configured to process, measure, analyze, detect and/or react to one or more of: data, temperature, humidity, sound, force, pressure, electromagnetic waves, position, distance, movement, flow, acceleration, speed, vibration, dust, light, glare, color, gas(es), and/or other aspects (e.g., characteristics) of an environment (e.g., of an enclosure).
- the gases may include volatile organic compounds (VOCs).
- the gases may include carbon monoxide, carbon dioxide, water vapor (e.g., humidity), oxygen, radon, and/or hydrogen sulfide.
- the one or more sensors may be calibrated in a factory setting.
- a sensor may be optimized to be capable of performing accurate measurements of one or more environmental characteristics present in the factory setting.
- a factory calibrated sensor may be less optimized for operation in a target environment.
- a factory setting may comprise a different environment than a target environment.
- the target environment can be an environment in which the sensor is deployed.
- the target environment can be an environment in which the sensor is expected and/or destined to operate.
- the target environment may differ from a factory environment.
- a factory environment corresponds to a location at which the sensor was assembled and/or built.
- the target environment may comprise a factory in which the sensor was not assembled and/or built.
- the factory setting may differ from the target environment to the extent that sensor readings captured in the target environment are erroneous (e.g., to a measurable extent).
- “erroneous” may refer to sensor readings that deviate from a specified accuracy (e.g., specified by a manufacture of the sensor). In some situations, a factory-calibrated sensor may provide readings that do not meet accuracy specifications (e.g., by a manufacturer) when operated in the target environments.
- the sensor(s) are operatively coupled to at least one controller and/or processor. Sensor readings may be obtained by one or more processors and/or controllers.
- a controller may comprise a processing unit (e.g., CPU or GPU).
- a controller may receive an input (e.g., from at least one sensor).
- the controller may comprise circuitry, electrical wiring, optical wiring, socket, and/or outlet.
- a controller may deliver an output.
- a controller may comprise multiple (e.g., sub-) controllers.
- the controller may be a part of a control system.
- a control system may comprise a master controller, network controller (e.g., floor controller), or a local controller.
- the local controller may control one or more targets (e.g., devices).
- the local controller may be a window controller (e.g., controlling an optically switchable window), enclosure controller, or target (e.g., component) controller.
- a controller may be a part of a hierarchal control system (e.g., comprising a main controller that directs one or more controllers, e.g., directs network controllers, local controllers (e.g., window controllers), enclosure controllers, and/or target (e.g., component) controllers).
- a physical location of the controller type in the hierarchal control system may be changing.
- a first processor may assume a role of a main controller, a second processor may assume a role of a network controller, and a third processor may assume the role of a local controller.
- the second processor may assume a role of a main controller, the first processor may assume a role of a network controller, and the third processor may remain with the role of a local controller.
- the third processor may assume a role of a main controller, the second processor may assume a role of a network controller, and the first processor may assume the role of a local controller.
- a controller may control one or more devices (e.g., be directly coupled to the devices).
- a controller may be disposed proximal to the one or more devices it is controlling.
- a controller may control an optically switchable device (e.g., IGU), an antenna, a sensor, and/or an output device (e.g., a light source, sounds source, smell source, gas source, HVAC outlet, or heater).
- a network controller may direct one or more local controllers, one or more enclosure controllers, one or more target (e.g., component) controllers, or any combination thereof.
- the network controller may comprise a floor controller.
- the network (e.g., comprising floor) controller may control a plurality of local (e.g., comprising window) controllers.
- a plurality of local controllers may be disposed in a portion of a facility (e.g., in a portion of a building).
- the portion of the facility may be a floor of a facility.
- a network controller may be assigned to a floor.
- a floor may comprise a plurality of network controllers, e.g., depending on the floor size and/or the number of local controllers coupled to the network controller.
- a network controller may be assigned to a portion of a floor.
- a network controller may be assigned to a portion of the local controllers disposed in the facility.
- a network controller may be assigned to a portion of the floors of a facility.
- a master controller may be coupled to one or more network controllers.
- the network controller may be disposed in the facility.
- the master controller may be disposed in the facility, or external to the facility.
- the master controller may be disposed in the cloud.
- a controller may be a part of, or be operatively coupled to, a building management system (abbreviated herein as “BMS”).
- BMS building management system
- a controller may receive one or more inputs.
- a controller may generate one or more outputs.
- the controller may be a single input single output controller (SISO) or a multiple input multiple output controller (MIMO).
- SISO single input single output controller
- MIMO multiple input multiple output controller
- a controller may interpret an input signal received.
- a controller may acquire data from the one or more targets (e.g., components such as sensors). Acquire may comprise receive or extract.
- the data may comprise measurement, estimation, determination, generation, or any combination thereof.
- a controller may comprise feedback control.
- a controller may comprise feed-forward control.
- Control may comprise on-off control, proportional control, proportional- integral (PI) control, or proportional-integral-derivative (PID) control.
- Control may comprise open loop control, or closed loop control.
- a controller may comprise closed loop control.
- a controller may comprise open loop control.
- a controller may comprise a user interface.
- a user interface may comprise (or operatively coupled to) a keyboard, keypad, mouse, touch screen, microphone, speech recognition package, camera, imaging system, or any combination thereof.
- Outputs may include a display (e.g., screen), speaker, or printer.
- the controller may perform real-time calculation (e.g., using communicated data such as sensor data and/or analytics of the cabling network).
- the network analytics may relate to the communication rate, (e.g., electrical) power consumption, and/or communication density on the network (e.g., at a given time, and/or at a given time frame).
- the controller e.g., control system
- the controller may utilize historical and/or third party data for its control.
- the historical data may be of the facility, of similar facilities, or of different facilities.
- Fig. 1 shows an example of a control system architecture 100 comprising a master controller 108 that controls network controllers 106, that in turn control local controllers 104.
- a local controller controls one or more IGUs, one or more sensors, one or more output devices (e.g., one or more emitters), or any combination thereof.
- Fig. 1 shows an example of a configuration in which the master controller is operatively coupled (e.g., wirelessly and/or wired) to a building management system (BMS) 124 and to a database 120. Arrows in FIG. 1 represents communication pathways.
- a controller may be operatively coupled (e.g., directly/indirectly and/or wired and/wirelessly) to an external source 110.
- the external source may comprise a network.
- the external source may comprise one or more sensor or output device.
- the external source may comprise a cloud- based application and/or database.
- the communication may be wired and/or wireless.
- the external source may be disposed external to the facility.
- the external source may comprise one or more sensors and/or antennas disposed, e.g., on a wall or on a ceiling of the facility.
- the communication may be monodirectional or bidirectional. In the example shown in Fig. 1 , all communication arrows are meant to be bidirectional.
- the controller may monitor and/or direct (e.g., physical) alteration of the operating conditions of the apparatuses, software, and/or methods described herein.
- Control may comprise regulate, manipulate, restrict, direct, monitor, adjust, modulate, vary, alter, restrain, check, guide, or manage.
- Controlled e.g., by a controller
- the control may comprise controlling a control variable (e.g. temperature, power, voltage, and/or profile).
- the control can comprise real time or off-line control. A calculation utilized by the controller can be done in real time, and/or offline.
- the controller may be a manual or a non-manual controller.
- the controller may be an automatic controller.
- the controller may operate upon request.
- the controller may be a programmable controller.
- the controller may be programmed.
- the controller may comprise a processing unit (e.g., CPU or GPU).
- the controller may receive an input (e.g., from at least one sensor).
- the controller may deliver an output.
- the controller may comprise multiple (e.g., sub-) controllers.
- the controller may be a part of a control system.
- the control system may comprise a master controller, network controller, local controller (e.g., enclosure controller, or window controller).
- the controller may receive one or more inputs.
- the controller may generate one or more outputs.
- the controller may be a single input single output controller (SISO) or a multiple input multiple output controller (MIMO).
- the controller may interpret the input signal received.
- the controller may acquire data from the one or more sensors.
- Acquire may comprise receive or extract.
- the data may comprise measurement, estimation, determination, generation, or any combination thereof.
- the controller may comprise feedback control.
- the controller may comprise feed-forward control.
- the control may comprise on-off control, proportional control, proportional-integral (PI) control, or proportional-integral-derivative (PID) control.
- the control may comprise open loop control, or closed loop control.
- the controller may comprise closed loop control.
- the controller may comprise open loop control.
- the controller may comprise a user interface.
- the user interface may comprise (or operatively coupled to) a keyboard, keypad, mouse, touch screen, microphone, speech recognition package, camera, imaging system, or any combination thereof.
- the outputs may include a display (e.g., screen), speaker, or printer.
- the methods, systems and/or the apparatus described herein may comprise a control system.
- the control system can be in communication with any of the apparatuses (e.g., sensors) described herein.
- the sensors may be of the same type or of different types, e.g., as described herein.
- the control system may be in communication with the first sensor and/or with the second sensor.
- the control system may control the one or more sensors.
- the control system may control one or more targets (e.g., components) of a building management system (e.g., lightening, security, and/or air conditioning system).
- the controller may regulate at least one (e.g., environmental) characteristic of the enclosure.
- the control system may regulate the enclosure environment using any target (e.g., component) of the building management system.
- the control system may regulate the energy supplied by a heating element and/or by a cooling element.
- the control system may regulate velocity of an air flowing through a vent to and/or from the enclosure.
- the control system may comprise a processor.
- the processor may be a processing unit.
- the controller may comprise a processing unit.
- the processing unit may be central.
- the processing unit may comprise a central processing unit (abbreviated herein as “CPU”).
- the processing unit may be a graphic processing unit (abbreviated herein as “GPU”).
- the controller(s) or control mechanisms may be programmed to implement one or more methods of the disclosure.
- the processor may be programmed to implement methods of the disclosure.
- the controller may control at least one target (e.g., component) of the forming systems and/or apparatuses disclosed herein.
- a plurality of targets may be operatively (e.g., communicatively) coupled to the control system.
- the control system may comprise the hierarchy of controllers.
- the targets may comprise an emitter, a sensor, or a window (e.g., IGU).
- the emitter may comprise light, buzzer, heater, HVAC actuators, or alarm.
- the target may be any target as disclosed herein.
- At least two of the plurality of targets may be of the same type. For example, two or more IGUs may be coupled to the control system.
- At least two of the plurality of targets may be of different types.
- a sensor and an emitter may be coupled to the control system.
- the plurality of targets may comprise at least 20, 50, 100, 500, 1000, 2500, 5000, 7500, 10000, 50000, 100000, or 500000 targets.
- the plurality of targets may be of any number between the aforementioned numbers (e.g., from 20 targets to 500000 targets, from 20 targets to 50 targets, from 50 targets to 500 targets, from 500 targets to 2500 targets, from 1000 targets to 5000 targets, from 5000 targets to 10000 targets, from 10000 targets to 100000 targets, or from 100000 targets to 500000 targets).
- the number of windows in a floor may be at least 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 40, or 50.
- the number of windows in a floor can be any number between the aforementioned numbers (e.g., from 5 to 50, from 5 to 25, or from 25 to 50).
- the targets may be in a multi-story building.
- At least a portion of the floors of the multi-story building may have targets controlled by the control system (e.g., at least a portion of the floors of the multi-story building may be controlled by the control system).
- the multi-story building may have at least 2, 8, 10, 25, 50, 80, 100, 120, 140, or 160 floors that are controlled by the control system.
- the number of floors (e.g., targets therein) controlled by the control system may be any number between the aforementioned numbers (e.g., from 2 to 50, from 25 to 100, or from 80 to 160).
- the floor may be of an area of at least about 150 m 2 , 250 m 2 ,
- the floor may have an area between any of the aforementioned floor area values (e.g., from about 150 m 2 to about 2000 m 2 , from about 150 m 2 to about 500 m 2, from about 250 m 2 to about 1000 m 2 , or from about 1000 m 2 to about 2000 m 2 ).
- the total length of cabling in the cabling network system can be at least about 500 feet (’), 1000’, 10000’, or 100000’, depending on the size of the facility, number and types of targets to which the cabling system is coupled, and coverage of the facility by the cabling system.
- portions of a communications network of the enclosure may be logically and/or physically divided into one or more vertical data planes and one or more horizontal data planes.
- a function of a vertical data plane may be to provide data communication and, optionally, electrical power vertically with respect to Earth (e.g., between floors of a multi-floor building).
- a function of a horizontal data plane may be to provide data communications and/or electrical power to network nodes on one or more floors of a facility (e.g., building).
- a communications network of an enclosure employs a vertical plane linked to a plurality of horizontal data planes by control panels. At least one control panel may be provided for each horizontal data plane.
- infrastructure described herein provides a communication network and electrical power resources around the perimeter of the enclosure (e.g., building), optionally with a separate communications and electrical power distribution system on each of multiple floors or on all floors of a facility (e.g., building).
- the infrastructure may be installed when the enclosure (e.g., building) is constructed or as part of a renovation.
- the infrastructure may provide high speed communications (e.g., at Gbit and faster data rates) and electrical power taps at specified locations throughout a building, for example around perimeter walls of a floor, room, along a ceiling, along a floor, or other region of a facility such as a building.
- direct connections to an infrastructure of a facility are provided via electrical power and/or communication docks in devices such as network adaptors described herein.
- Wires that connect to network adaptors may be strung in various locations such as in the walls of an enclosure (e.g., a building).
- one or more wires are disposed in a horizontal mullion above and/or below a window.
- one or more wires are disposed underneath a floor surface, e.g., within a floor plate.
- the links in the vertical data plane are links between network devices (e.g., devices that are communicatively coupled to a network).
- the one or more network devices may be disposed on the same floor and/or on different floors of a facility (e.g., building).
- a network device such as a network switch and/or a network router.
- the network device may be connected to two or more links in a vertical data plane.
- the network device may be provided in a control panel.
- the link medium (in the vertical plane) comprises and/or is comprised of, one or more optical fibers.
- electrical current carrying wire(s) are used in place of, and/or in conjunction with, optical fibers, e.g., as link media (e.g., in the vertical data plane).
- the optical fiber(s) may be disposed in a horizontal and/or vertical data plane.
- Current carrying wire(s), such as copper wire(s) may be provided as twisted pair and/or coaxial cable.
- the (e.g., vertical) data plane includes bundles of fibers running between network devices (disposed, for example, on different floors of a facility (e.g., building)).
- the links of the (e.g., vertical) data plane depicted in Fig. 2, 213, 215, or 217 may (e.g., each) comprise a bundle of fibers.
- at least one (e.g., each) bundle of fibers may include at least 12, 24, 48, 96, or 114 optical fibers.
- At least a portion of the optical fiber(s) may be utilized for communication in an enclosure. At least a portion of the optical fibers may not be utilized (e.g., non-utilized fiber(s) may be referred to herein as “dark fiber(s)”). In some implementations, during or after installation, some fibers are used for an information technology (IT) and/or other services infrastructure of an enclosure (e.g., building), while some other fibers are “dark.” Dark fibers may not be utilized, at least temporarily, for IT and/or services (e.g., sensors, windows, HVAC, lighting, security) of an enclosure.
- IT information technology
- other services infrastructure of an enclosure e.g., building
- Dark fibers may not be utilized, at least temporarily, for IT and/or services (e.g., sensors, windows, HVAC, lighting, security) of an enclosure.
- the heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning system may be abbreviated herein as “HVAC.”
- the services may comprise controlling operations of one or more devices.
- the devices may comprise a sensor, tintable window, heater, cooler (e.g., air-conditioner), ventilator, lighting, security, emitters, antenna, or actuators.
- at least about 1/10, 1/5, 1/4, 1/3, or 1/2 (half) of the installed fibers are initially, upon installation, dark.
- at least about 1/10, 1/5, 1/4, 1/3, or 1/2 (half) of the installed fibers are initially, upon installation, not dark.
- the dark fiber may be used for leasing as a service to tenants and/or other enclosure occupants. Examples of leased services may include Wi-Fi, cellular communications, streaming internet, and any other IT related services utilized by occupants and/or tenants.
- a data plane has a topology (e.g., the wires and/or devices operatively coupled to the wires are configured in a topology).
- the topology may be linear or star topology.
- a (e.g., horizontal) data plane may have a linear network topology.
- the network topology may include a control panel at one terminus of a data transmission medium and multiple nodes connected along the length of the data transmission medium (downstream from the control panel).
- the transmission medium e.g., a network cable such as a coaxial and/or a twisted pair cable
- the transmission medium is located around some or all the perimeter of a floor of a facility.
- the electrical couplings are caps, which are passive devices.
- the cap can provide an electrical coupling between the network cable and an associated nodes (e.g., any one of the devices served by the horizontal data plane).
- the electrical couplings are provided at regular intervals such as at (e.g., vertical) mullions (e.g., at about every five feet).
- the nodes may be infrastructure nodes.
- the infrastructure nodes may include floor controller, ethernet switch, and/or head-end.
- Fig. 2 presents an embodiment of a communications network 200 for an enclosure such as a building.
- the example shown in Fig. 2 depicts links that may comprise one or more cables (e.g., coaxial cables or twisted cables).
- the link may be a communication and/or electrical power line.
- the cables may be a cable bundle.
- the cable bundle can transmit electrical power and/or communication.
- the cable e.g., coaxial cable
- network 200 includes a vertically oriented network portion (including a vertical communication line 205) that connects network targets (e.g., components) on multiple floors of the enclosure (e.g., of the facility).
- network targets e.g., components
- a vertical data plane comprises a first control panel 207 on a first floor, a second control panel 209 on a second floor, and a third control panel 211 on third floor.
- Physical communications and/or electrical power link 213 connects control panels 207 and 209.
- Physical communications and/or electrical power link 215 connects control panels 209 and 211 .
- Physical communications and/or electrical power link 217 connects control panels 207 and 211. As illustrated, control panels 207, 209, and 211 along with physical communications and/or power links 213, 215, and 217 form a loop. The loop may provide redundancy in the network.
- physical communications and/or electrical power link 217 provides redundancy on the vertical plane if one of the other physical communications and/or electrical power links (e.g., link 213 or 215) should fail.
- Communications links 213, 215, and 217 may comprise electrical wires and/or optical fibers.
- Communications and/or links 213, 215, and 217 may comprise a coaxial wire.
- control panel 207 is communicatively coupled (e.g., connected) to an external network 201 (e.g., external to the building and/or in the cloud) via an access network 203.
- Control panel 207 is communicatively coupled (e.g., connected) to access network 203 by a physical communications and/or electrical power link 204, which may comprise an optical fiber and/or an electrical wire.
- Control panel 207 is connected to an antenna 289 that is external to the building.
- the antennal 289 may be a receiving antenna (e.g., a donor antenna).
- Fig. 2 shows an example of control panel 207 that is operatively coupled (e.g., connected) to a first horizontal network portion that is horizontal data plane 219.
- Control panel 209 is operatively coupled (e.g., connected) to a second horizontal network portion that is horizontal data plane 221 .
- Control panel 211 is operatively coupled (e.g., connected) to a third horizontal network portion that is horizontal data plane 223.
- the horizontal data planes 219, 221 , and 223 include multiple network targets (e.g., components and/or devices).
- the network targets e.g., components
- the client nodes can be located on respective floors of the building.
- horizontal data plane 219 includes network adaptors 251a-251e.
- the network adapter e.g., 251a
- the network adapter is coupled to communication and/or electrical power line (e.g., trunk line) 259 via a distribution junction (e.g., 290).
- Network adaptor 251a is connected to a collection of targets (e.g., sensors and/or emitters) 253 and connected to an IGU 255 that may be an optically switchable window.
- targets 253 also referred to herein as “target ensemble”
- PoE Power over Ethernet protocol
- Network adaptor 251 d is connected to at least one third-party device 257 such as a computation device.
- Network adaptor 251 d is configured to provide network connectivity to third party device 257.
- Providing the network connectivity may comprise logic implementing a link layer discovery protocol (LLDP) that supports, e.g., PoE.
- LLDP link layer discovery protocol
- control panel 207 is connected to network adaptors 251a-251e by a link (e.g., coaxial cable) 259.
- the connection can be by a coaxial or other type of (e.g., electrical and/or optical) cable.
- Control panel 209 is connected to client nodes on horizontal data plane 221 by a link (e.g., coaxial cable) 261.
- Control panel 211 is connected to client nodes on horizontal data plane 223 by a link (e.g., coaxial cable) 263.
- a link e.g., coaxial cable
- control panel 207 comprises two head ends 265a and 265b, a switch 267 (abbreviated herein as “SW”) and a distributed antenna system (abbreviated herein as “DAS”) 269.
- the Switch is operatively coupled (e.g., connected to two edge distribution frame devices (abbreviated herein as “EDFs”).
- Head end 265a is connected to multiple links (e.g., coaxial cables), including link (e.g., coaxial cable) 259. While not shown, head end 265b is connected to at least one link (e.g., coaxial cable).
- Switch 267 is connected to (e.g., communication and/or electrical power) links 204, 213, and 217. The connection may be via optical and/or electrical cable(s).
- DAS 269 is configured to control and/or communicate with one or more antennas, including antenna 273, on horizontal data plane 219.
- the antenna may be an internal building antenna (e.g., 273) and/or or an external (e.g., donor) antenna (e.g., 289).
- an electrical power and/or communications link (e.g., cable) 271 connects antenna 273 to control panel 207.
- Link 271 is also connected to a directional coupler (e.g., configured for directional data communication protocol such as MoCA or d.hn).
- Other client nodes 275a and 275b are connected to control panel 207 via electrical power and/or communications link (e.g., cable) 271 .
- Head ends 265a and 265b are configured to send and/or receive data encoded in accordance with one or more protocols which comprise (i) a next generation home networking protocol (abbreviated herein as “G.hn” protocol), (ii) communications technology that transmits digital information over electrical power lines that traditionally used to (e.g., only) deliver electrical power, or (iii) hardware devices designed for communication and transfer of data (e.g., Ethernet, USB and Wi-Fi) through electrical wiring of a building.
- the data transfer protocols may facilitate data transmission rates of at least 1 Gigabits per second (Gbit/s), 2 Gbit/s, 3 Gbit/s, 4 Gbit/s, or 5 Gbit/s.
- the data transfer protocol may operate over telephone wiring, coaxial cables, electrical power lines, and/or (e.g., plastic) optical fiber.
- the data transfer protocol may be facilitated using a chip (e.g., comprising a semiconductor device).
- a chip e.g., comprising a semiconductor device.
- Horizontal data plane 221 includes a network adaptor 277 connected to control panel 209 by a link (e.g., coaxial cable) 279.
- Horizontal data plane 221 includes a physical power (e.g., 48V DC) and/or (electrical power and/or communications) line 281 for connecting one or more antennas (not shown) to control panel 209.
- Horizontal data plane 223 includes, in addition to link (e.g., coaxial cable) 263, a second link (e.g., coaxial cable) 283 for connecting to one or more network adaptors or other client nodes (not shown) to control panel 211 .
- Horizontal data plane 223 includes a physical (e.g., electrical power and/or communications) line 285 for connecting one or more antennas (not shown) to control panel 211 .
- Control panel 211 is also connected to a (e.g., cellular) antenna 287.
- control panels include one or more head ends configured to communicate via protocol such as G.hn, Ethernet (including via a MoCA (Multimedia over Coax Alliance) protocol), and/or any one or more of various cellular protocols such as fourth generation (4G) and/or fifth generation (5G) cellular communication.
- the 4G communication may comply with Long-Term Evolution (LTE) standard.
- Control panels may comprise one or more network switches, gateways, and/or routers.
- a cabling network includes at least one distribution junction (referred to herein as “splitter” and “junction”).
- the distribution junction may include at least one connector.
- the distribution junction may distribute one or more time-varying signals and/or electrical (e.g., DC) power within a network infrastructure.
- the distribution junction may couple together two or more circuits.
- the distribution junction may couple together at least two of an upstream circuit, a downstream circuit, and a branch circuit.
- the upstream and downstream circuits may be part of a network bus (also referred to herein as a trunk line).
- a bus is a subsystem that is used to connect targets (e.g., components) transfer data (e.g., signal) and/or electrical (e.g., DC) power between those targets (e.g., components).
- targets e.g., components
- the distribution junction can be passive, or active.
- the distribution junction may comprise active and passive targets (e.g., components).
- the distribution junction may include one or more paths in the upstream, downstream, and branch circuits that are electrically coupled together.
- the distribution junction can include, or be operatively coupled to, a microprocessor.
- the cabling network may include a passive distribution junction and/or an active distribution junction.
- An active distribution junction has at least one active component.
- a passive distribution junction has passive component(s) and no active components.
- the active distribution junction includes circuitry (e.g., electrical circuitry).
- the circuitry in the active distribution junction may include a signal repeater, range extender, signal transponder, an amplifier, a pre-amplifier, power management circuitry, and/or a microprocessor.
- the power management circuitry may control (e.g., monitor and/or manage) electrical (e.g., DC) power flows through the distribution junction.
- the active distribution junction may facilitate formation of a longer network bus (e.g., signal repeaters and/or amplifiers can extend the practical length of the network bus).
- the active distribution junction may provide an option to resize (e.g., lengthen) the network (e.g., by adding signal repeaters and/or amplifiers) dynamically.
- Resizing the network may comprise resizing the network bus.
- the dynamic network resizing option may provide dynamic extension and/or contraction of the network.
- the dynamic network resizing option may facilitate formation of a labile network, e.g., in terms of its size and/or connectivity of targets to the distribution junction.
- the active distribution junction may facilitate power management in the network infrastructure. For example, (i) by monitoring voltage and/or current along the network (e.g., along the network bus), and/or (ii) by negotiating power consumption for targets (e.g., components) coupled to the branch circuit.
- the distribution junction is passive.
- the passive distribution junction can include one or more capacitors, inductors, and/or transformers.
- the passive distribution junction may include (i) a first inductor coupling electrical (e.g., DC) power, e.g., from the upstream circuit to the branch circuit (or vice-versa) and/or (ii) a second inductor coupling electrical (e.g., DC) power, e.g., from the upstream circuit to the downstream circuit (or vice-versa).
- the passive distribution junction can include at least one transformer.
- the at least one transformer may couple one or more time-varying signals between two or more circuits (e.g., between three circuits).
- the passive distribution junction can include one or more filters.
- the distribution junction provides impedance matching.
- the distribution junction may comprise a transformer.
- implementations of a distribution junction that utilizes a transformer can provide impedance matching.
- the impedance matching may serve to reduce (e.g., eliminate) unwanted signal reflections off of distribution junctions within the network infrastructure.
- the transformer can comprise a plurality of windings. At least two (e.g., all) of the plurality of windings may be formed from the same number of turns around a common core (e.g., to provide a balanced transformer). At least two (e.g., all) of the plurality of windings may be formed from different number of turns around a common core (e.g., to provide an unbalanced transformer).
- the diameters of at least two (e.g., all) of the windings may be the same.
- the diameter of at least two (e.g., all) of the windings may be different.
- the transformer (in the distribution junction) may be configured to divide time-varying signals in a balanced or in an unbalanced manner.
- the balanced transformer may receive a time-varying signal on a first circuit and divide the signal equally onto a plurality of circuits.
- the equal division of the signal into the plurality of circuits may be such that the signal in each of the plurality of circuits is approximately (e.g., measurably) equal.
- the balanced transformer may receive a time-varying signal on first circuit and equally divides the signal onto the second and third circuits (e.g., at approximately one-half the original power).
- the unbalanced transformer may receive a time- varying signal on a first circuit and divide the signal unequally onto a plurality of circuits.
- the unequal division of the signal into the plurality of circuits may be such that the signal in at least two of the plurality of circuits is different.
- the unbalanced transformer may divide the signal from the first circuit onto a second circuit at a first fraction (e.g., 85%) of the original (e.g., electrical) power and onto the third circuit at a second fraction (e.g., 15%) of the original power.
- the first and second fractions are unequal and sum to approximately 100% (e.g., 100% less losses).
- the second circuit may receive at most about 1%, 5%, 10%, 15%, 20%, 25%, 30%, or 40% of the signal from the first circuit, and the third circuit may receive the remainder of the signal from the first circuit.
- the second circuit may receive any signal percentage value between the aforementioned percentage values from the first circuity (e.g., from about 1% to about 40%, from about 1% to about 20%, or from about 20% to about 40%), and the third circuit may receive the remainder of the signal from the first circuit.
- the second circuit e.g., the circuit receiving the lower signal strength
- the third circuit may be the downstream circuit, e.g., such that the majority of the signal continues along the network bus.
- the first circuit e.g., the circuit receiving the higher signal strength
- the distribution junction includes at least one filter.
- the distribution junction may include one or more low-pass filters, high-pass filters, and/or bandpass filters.
- the filters may serve to minimize (e.g., block) certain frequencies from a branch circuit (e.g., when such frequencies are not utilized by that branch circuit) and/or from a downstream circuit (e.g., when no downstream circuits utilize such frequencies).
- the filters may reduce noise in the network, e.g., as the signal propagates through the network (e.g., through the bus).
- the distribution junction includes frequency shifting capabilities.
- the control panel and distribution junctions may frequency-shift one or more of the time-varying signals to reduce interference as the signals travel through the network. Signals may be shifted into regions of the spectrum available on the medium (e.g., coaxial cable) that are not being used.
- the distribution junction may include passive or active targets (e.g., components) that remove this frequency shift when conveying signals from a network bus to a branch circuit and that insert this frequency shift when conveying signals from the branch circuit to the network bus.
- the control panel may include a G.hn head-end (or other target (e.g., component) that adds and removes frequency shifts to the time-varying signals as they are transmitted by and received at the control panel.
- one or more antennas are coupled to the network.
- the antennas can be external and/or internal to the enclosure (e.g., building).
- the antenna can be passive or active. At least two of the antennas can be of the same type. At least two of the antennas can be of different type.
- the external antenna can be referred to herein as “donor antenna.”
- the external antenna may be a directional antenna (e.g., Yagi antenna).
- the antenna can be directly coupled to the control panel.
- the antenna can be indirectly coupled to the control panel. Indirect coupling of the antenna to the control panel may comprise its coupling through one or more distribution junctions.
- the signal from the antenna may travel a distance through the cable, e.g., resulting in a reduction in the signal to noise ratio, e.g., reduction of the signal strength as compared to the noise.
- the signal from the antenna may travel through one or more distribution junctions, e.g., resulting in a reduction in the signal to noise ratio, e.g., reduction of the signal strength as compared to the noise.
- the network may include a pre-amplifier and/or amplifier (e.g., to increase the signal to noise ratio, e.g., to increase the signal strength as compared to the noise).
- the amplifier and/or preamplifier can be (i) disposed adjacent to the antenna, (ii) as part of the antenna circuitry, (iii) as part of the controller (e.g., in the control panel), (iv) operatively coupled to the controller, (v) adjacent to a distribution junction, and/or (vi) operatively coupled to a distribution junction.
- the antenna may be active.
- the antenna may include an amplifier and/or pre-amplifier.
- antenna 273 is connected to control panel 207 through head 265a. However, the antenna may be communicatively coupled to the cable (e.g., coax and/or trunk line 265a).
- the antenna can be connected to the trunk line before any distribution junction (e.g., 290) and/or other target (e.g., device such as 253). Without wishing to be bound to theory, connection of the antenna to the trunk line before any distribution junction and/or device, may reduce signal loss (as compared to the noise).
- the amplifier and/or pre-amplifier can be included in the control panel, e.g., of the floor controller.
- the network bus has a head-end.
- One or more devices may be coupled to the network bus.
- the antennas may be high frequency antennas.
- the antennas may operate at a frequency range of from about 700MHz to about 2100MHz.
- the antennas may be coupled closer to the head-end than (e.g., upstream of) other devices.
- the first device on the network bus e.g., the branch circuit nearest the head-end
- the second device may be another antenna operating at least about 700 MHz
- other (e.g., downstream) devices coupled to the network bus may utilize signals at frequencies of at most about 400 MHz.
- the highest frequency (e.g., 3.56 GHz) antenna may be connected to the network bus with a first distribution junction having a first low-pass filter, e.g., disposed on the downstream circuit.
- the first low-pass filter may attenuate (e.g., block) signals on the downstream circuit having frequencies above the frequency of the antenna (e.g., of about 3.20 GHz).
- the lower frequency (e.g., 700 MHz) antenna may be connected to the network bus with a second distribution junction having a second low-pass filter, e.g., on the downstream circuit.
- the second low-pass filter may attenuate (e.g., block) signals on the downstream circuit having frequencies above the frequency of that antenna (e.g., of about 400 MHz).
- the signals of both (e.g., 3.56 GHz and 700 MHz) antennas need not pass through more than a limited number (e.g., one, two, etc.) of distribution junctions.
- the number of distribution junctions through high higher frequency signals pass may be a single digit integer (e.g., at most 1 , 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 distribution junctions).
- the antennas may receive a higher signal strength (e.g., higher signal to noise ratio).
- high-frequency noise from downstream reflections and/or other sources can be reduced (e.g., eliminated).
- Fig. 3 shows an example of a cabling network 300.
- the cabling network includes a bus cable 350 that is connected to a controller 306.
- the controller can comprise a network (e.g., comprising floor) controller.
- the controller can include a network controller.
- the controller can be a main controller.
- Fig. 3 shows an example of a plurality of distribution junctions 301 , 302, and 303.
- Distribution junction 301 is connected via branch cable 351 to antenna 321.
- Antenna 321 can be the highest frequency antenna (e.g., 3.56GHz) coupled to bus cable 350.
- Distribution junction 302 is connected via branch cable 352 to antenna 322.
- Antenna 322 can be the lower frequency antenna (e.g., 700MHz).
- Fig. 1 shows an example of a cabling network 300.
- the cabling network includes a bus cable 350 that is connected to a controller 306.
- the controller can comprise a network (e.g., comprising floor) controller.
- the antennas 321 and 322 are dome antennas.
- Fig. 3 shows an example of a third disturbing junction 303 connected via branch cable 353 to a local (e.g., comprising window) controller 341 , that is in turn connected to IGU 342 and sensor 343.
- the local controller may be a microprocessor.
- Fig. 3 shows a detailed electronic schematic of distribution junction 301 as 310.
- the detailed electronic schematic 310 includes a transformer that divides the power of time- varying signals between the upstream, downstream, and branch circuits.
- distribution junction 310 includes first and second inductors that couple electrical (e.g., DC) power between the upstream, downstream, and branch circuits.
- the branch circuit of distribution junction 310 is coupled to a highest frequency antenna and the distribution junction 310 includes a low pass filter.
- the low pass filter is formed from an inductor and a capacitor coupled to the downstream circuit.
- the low-pass filter may attenuate (e.g., block) signals utilized by the highest frequency (e.g., 3.56 GHz) antenna from the downstream circuit.
- the downstream devices e.g., 322, 342, and 343 may utilize frequencies lower than those attenuated by the low-pass filter.
- the transformer in distribution junction 310 includes a first winding 361 , a second winding 362, and a third winding 363.
- the windings 361 , 362, and 363 are wound around a common core.
- Fig. 3 shows an example of a distribution junction 380 that connects three coaxial cables.
- a cabling network includes a network bus (also referred to herein as a trunk line) and branch cables.
- the network bus and branch cables may distribute one or more time-varying signals and/or electrical (e.g., DC) power within a network infrastructure.
- the network bus and branch cables may include one or more signal conductors and one or more ground conductors.
- the network bus may be formed of multiple circuits coupled together.
- a first circuit of the network bus may couple together a controller (e.g., controller 306 of Fig. 3) and a distribution junction (e.g., distribution junction 301 of Fig. 3).
- Second and subsequent circuits of the network bus may couple together respective pairs of distribution junctions (e.g., pairs of distribution junctions 301 , 302, and 303).
- a branch cable (e.g., branch cables 351 , 352, and 352) may couple a branch circuit to a respective distribution junction.
- the network bus and branch cables may (e.g., simultaneously) distribute multiple time-varying signals and/or electrical (e.g., DC) power.
- the network bus and branch cables may convey electrical (e.g., DC) power at any desired nominal voltage.
- the network bus and branch cables may convey electrical (e.g., DC) power at 12V, at 23V, or at 48 volts (V).
- the network bus and branch cables may follow any International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) class such as class 0, I, II, or III.
- IEC International Electrotechnical Commission
- the network bus and branch cables may abide by class II of IEC and may thus carry a maximum of 100VA or 100 Watts.
- the network bus and branch cables may have a wire thickness (e.g., 12, 14, 16 or 18 gauge) sufficient to carry the requested current.
- the network bus and branch cables may include shielding (e.g., foil shielding, braided shielding, or quad shielding), e.g., to reduce crosstalk and/or interference.
- the network bus and branch cables may comprise (e.g., be formed from) LMR-200, LMR-240, LMR-400, RG-6, RG-8, RG-11 , RG-59, RG-60, RG-174, RG-210, RG-213, 8233, or 8267 coaxial cable, or another type of cable.
- the network bus and/or branch cables may distribute any requested number (e.g., 1 , 2, 3, 4, 5, or more) of distinguishable time-varying signal frequency sets.
- the time-varying signal frequency sets may be distributed over nonoverlapping frequencies windows.
- the network bus and/or branch cables may distribute a first frequency set of time-varying signals over one or more first frequency windows and a second set of time-varying signal frequency over one or more second frequency windows.
- Frequency windows in both the first and second sets may be separated in the frequency-domain (e.g., there may be guard bands between the frequency windows).
- some frequency windows from the first and/or second sets are not separated by a guard band and/or are partially overlapping in the frequency- domain (e.g., one frequency window end contact another frequency window beginning, e.g., Fig. 5, 526 and 529).
- separating frequency-adjacent frequency windows with guard bands reduces noise and/or interference, and can also reduce the cost and complexity of network components (e.g., cables, filters, distribution junctions, etc.).
- the first set of time-varying signals distributed by the cabling network may include network data signals (e.g., control related signals).
- the first set of time-varying signals may be referred to as digital communications or digital data.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals configured to be transmitted by communications technology that transmits digital information over electrical power lines that used to (e.g., only) deliver electrical power.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals configured to be transmitted by hardware devices designed for communication and transfer of data (e.g., Ethernet, USB and Wi-Fi) through electrical wiring of a building.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals configured to be transmitted by a data transfer protocol that facilitates data transmission rates of at least 1 Megahertz (MHz), 5 MHz, 10 MHz, 50 MHz,
- the data transfer protocol may operate over telephone wiring, coaxial cables, electrical power lines, and/or (e.g., plastic) optical fiber.
- the data transfer protocol may be facilitated using a chip (e.g., comprising a semiconductor device).
- the first set of time-varying signals may include power line communications signals, such as G.hn, HomePlug®, or HD-PLC compatible signals.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals compatible with the multimedia over coax alliance (MoCA) protocol.
- MoCA multimedia over coax alliance
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals compatible with other protocols including Ethernet protocols such as 802.3bw, 802.3bp, 802.3ch, and/or 802.3cq.
- the first frequency window may extend from approximately 2 Megahertz (MHz) to approximately 200 MHz (e.g., such as used in the G.hn protocol). As an example, the first frequency window may extend from approximately 500 MHz to approximately 600 MHz, from approximately 875 MHz to approximately 1 Ghz, or from approximately 1 .15 to approximately 1 .5 GHz.
- the second set of time-varying signals distributed by the cabling network may include radio-frequency signals.
- the second-time varying signals may include signals received by or for transmission through an antenna.
- the second frequency windows may extend from approximately 600 MHz to approximately 1 GHz, from approximately 1 .4 GHz to approximately 6 GHz, from approximately 1 .7 GHz to approximately 6 GHz.
- the radiofrequency signals may include cellular network signals such as fourth-generation (4G) and/or fifth-generation (5G) cellular network signals.
- the 4G and 5G cellular network signals include signals at or below approximately 6 GHz.
- the ranges of the first and second set of time varying signals may overlap.
- the ranges of the first and second set of time varying signals may be separate. The separation may by a signal domain that is not occupied by the first or by the second time varying signals.
- Fig. 4 depicts a network cable 400.
- the network buss(es) and branch cables in the cabling network disclosed herein may be formed from network cable 400.
- Network cable 400 includes an inner conductor 401 , insulator 402 (also referred to as dielectric), outer conductor 403, and insulator 404 (also referred to as a jacket or shell).
- Outer conductor 403 can serve as a grounding path.
- Inner conductor 401 can carry direct current (DC).
- the electromagnetic field carrying the signal is transmitted (e.g., mainly or only) in the space between the inner conductor 401 and the outer conductors 403.
- the coaxial cable can provides protection of the signal from external electromagnetic interference (e.g., may reduce external electromagnetic interference on the signal transmitted in the coaxial cable).
- network cable 400 may be an LMR-200, LMR-240, LMR-400, RG-6, RG-8, RG-11 , RG-59, RG-60, RG-174, RG-210, RG-213, 8233, or 8267 coaxial cable, or another type of cable.
- Fig. 5 depicts various frequency ranges 500, 510, and 520 of distinguishable signal range divisions along a frequency range that may be conveyed by the network cable 400.
- Frequency range 500 includes DC signal 501 , first set of time-varying signal frequencies 502 (e.g., of control related communication), and second set of time-varying signal frequencies 504 (e.g., related to media (e.g., cellular) communication).
- the first and second time-varying signal frequency sets 502 and 503 are separated by frequency guard band 503 (e.g., devoid of time-varying signals).
- Frequency range 510 includes DC signal 511 , first time-varying signal frequency set 512 (e.g., of control related communication), second time-varying signal frequency set 514 (e.g., related to media (e.g., cellular) communication), third time-varying signal frequency set 516 (e.g., of control related communication), and fourth time-varying signal frequency set 518 (e.g., related to media (e.g., cellular) communication).
- Guard bands 513, 515, and 517 separate respective pairs of the time-varying signals. Guard bands 513, 515, and 517 may be devoid of time-varying signal.
- At least two of the time-varying signal frequency set may transmit signals of the same type (e.g., signal frequency sets 512 and 516 may be reserved for transmission of control related communication). At least two of the time-varying signal frequency set may transmit signals of a different type (e.g., signal frequency set 512 may be reserved for transmission of control related communication and frequency set 514 may be reserved for transmission of media related communication).
- time-varying signal frequency set 512 may be reserved for data signals from about 2 to about 200 MHz (e.g., that complies with the G.hn protocol).
- time- varying signal frequency set 516 may be reserved for data signals from about 1.2 to about 1 .5 GHz that comply with the MoCA (Multimedia over Coax Alliance) protocol.
- MoCA Multimedia over Coax Alliance
- time-varying signal frequency sets 514 and 516 may be reserved for analog radiofrequency signals with signal frequency set 514 including frequencies from about 0.6 to about 1 .0 GHz and signal frequency set 518 may be reserved for signal frequencies from about 1 .7 to about 6.0 Ghz.
- Signal frequency range 520 of distinguishable signal frequencies includes DC signal 521 , first time-varying signal frequency set 522, second time-varying signal frequency set 524, third time-varying signal frequency set 526, and fourth time-varying signal frequency set 529.
- Guard band 523 represents the relatively wide spectrum guard band between signals 522 and 524 (e.g., that is devoid of signals).
- Guard band 525 represents a relatively narrow spectrum guard band between signals 524 and 526 (e.g., that is devoid of signals).
- a sharp guard band 527 separates signal sets 526 and 529.
- Guard band 527 may have a width of a single frequency, less than 10 signal frequencies, or have a zero frequency range (and thus signal sets 526 and 529 may contact each other).
- Time-varying signal 529 may be separated from time varying signal frequency set 530 by a notch guard band 528 (e.g., that is devoid of signals).
- Signals in a signal frequency set may have the same amplitude throughout the signal frequency set (e.g., 529).
- Signals in the signal frequency set may have a varying amplitude (e.g., comprising an amplitude ramp up, amplitude plateau, and amplitude ramp down such as in 502).
- the slope of the ramp up and ramp down may have the same absolute value.
- the slop of the ramp up and ramp down have a different absolute value.
- the signal frequency set may be a frequency window in which a set of signal frequencies are permitted to be transmitted along the transmission line (e.g., coaxial cable).
- Frequencies for transmission may follow jurisdictionally allowed standards of communications.
- Maintenance and/or facilitation of division into frequency domains may comprise utilization of one or more signal filters.
- facilitation of the wide guard bands e.g., 503
- filters that are less precise e.g., and cheaper
- filters facilitating sharp e.g., 527 and 528, and/or short (e.g., 525) band gaps, or sharp frequency domain division
- the network infrastructure may include one or more network adapters.
- the network adapters may be configured to tap off electrical power and data (e.g., G.hn and/or MoCA formatted data) at various locations on the horizontal data plane portion of a network.
- the network adapters are coupled to respective branch cables (also referred to as branch lines) and/or to network bus (also reference to as a trunk line) in a cabling network.
- the cabling network can include one or more network buses.
- the network adaptors are configured to provide signal and/or electrical power to downstream targets such as devices (e.g., end nodes associated with a respective branch line).
- the signal may comprise digital data such as Ethernet data.
- the network adapters serve as 100 Mega Bit (Mbit) and/or 1000Mbit Ethernet adaptors.
- the network adaptors may alternatively or additionally be configured to provide downstream targets (e.g., devices) with electrical power (e.g., DC power).
- the electrical power may be at a voltage of at least about 24 volts (V), 48V, or 96V.
- the electrical power may be at a voltage of at most about 24V, 48V, or 96V.
- An end node coupled to a network adaptor may receive electrical power from, and/or receive and transmit data through, the connected network adaptor.
- a digital architectural element e.g., comprising a tintable window
- the digital architectural element may include one or more sensors.
- the sensor(s) may be coupled to the network infrastructure, e.g., through the connected network adapter.
- a node that can use electrical power and/or data network communications may be coupled to the network infrastructure, e.g., via a network adapter.
- the cabling system and at least a portion of its components may support electrical power of at least about 50 Watt (W), 100 W, 200W, 400W, 600W, 1000W, or 5000W.
- the cabling network may comprise, or be operatively coupled to, a network adapter.
- the network adapter may include one or more network components for distributing electrical power internally and/or externally.
- the network adapter may comprise one or more network components for handling (e.g., DC) electrical power.
- the electrical power can be AC or DC power.
- the power handling network components may include one or more (e.g., DC-to-DC) converters.
- the network comprises a DC-to-AC, AC-to-DC, AC-to-AC, or DC-to-DC converter.
- the converter may be operatively coupled to, or be a part of, the network adapter.
- the DC-to-DC converter may be configured to convert a DC voltage received from the network bus into a different voltage (e.g., higher voltage and/or lower voltage).
- the DC-to-DC converters may include one or more electronic converters such as a step-down (e.g., buck) converter and/or a step-up (e.g., boost) converter.
- the outputs of DC-to-DC converters in the network adapter may be used internally by the network adapter (e.g., to power internal network components such as processors, interfaces, and controllers) and/or externally (e.g., to provide power to end nodes).
- the network adapter may provide electrical power to one or more end nodes, e.g., through an adapter or connector.
- the network adapter may provide DC power to a Power over Ethernet (PoE) switch, coupler, and/or injector.
- the Power over Ethernet (PoE) switch, coupler, and/or injector may provide the DC power to end nodes, e.g., over twisted pair Ethernet cabling.
- the DC handling network components may include one or more filters and/or power conditioning devices.
- the DC handling network components can include one or more inductors configured to block time-varying signals between the end nodes, network bus, and/or DC-to-DC converters.
- the network adapter may include network components for handling data communications.
- the network adapter may include a processor, an interface for coupling to the network bus, and/or one or more interfaces for coupling to end nodes. These network components may receive (e.g., and be powered by) one or more (e.g., DC) signals received from the network bus and/or generated internally by one or more (e.g., DC- to-DC) converters.
- the interface for coupling to the network bus may encode and decode data conveyed on the network bus.
- the interface for coupling to the network bus may be a data interface (also referred to as a data controller).
- the interface for coupling to the network bus may be a G.Hn interface (also referred to as a G.Hn controller).
- the interfaces for coupling to one or more end nodes may include, as examples, (i) a data and/or electrical power interface and (ii) an architectural element interface.
- the general-purpose data and/or electrical power interface may be an Ethernet interface or a Power over Ethernet interface, as examples.
- Ethernet interfaces and Power over Ethernet interfaces may be referred to as Ethernet and Power over Ethernet controllers, respectively.
- the architectural element interface may include, as an example, a window controller (which is a type of a local controller).
- the window controller may provide one or more signals, e.g., responsive to tint commands, to a tintable window effect to adjust the tint of the tintable window.
- the tint commands may be generated internally by the window controller (e.g., in response to logic programmed into the window controller) or may be received over the network bus from a higher-level window controller in the hierarchy of controllers.
- the window controller may receive signals, e.g., from the tintable window and/or from any connected sensors.
- the connected sensors may be associated with sensed environmental conditions (e.g., weather conditions such as sunlight and/or cloudiness) and/or a tint status of the tintable window.
- the window controller may use such signals internally (e.g., in generating tint commands) or may convey such signals to other network components, e.g., over the network bus.
- the network adaptor may have a relatively small chassis or footprint.
- a fundamental length scale may be a width, length, height, diameter of a circle, or diameter of a bounding circle, and may be abbreviated herein as “FLS.”
- the fundamental length scale of the network adaptor may be at most about 1 cm, 2cm, 5cm, 10cm, 20cm, or 50cm.
- the FLS of the network adaptor may be of any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 1cm to about 50cm, from about 1cm to about 10cm, or from about 10cm to about 50cm). In some embodiments, no dimension is greater than about 12 inches or greater than about 10 inches.
- the network adaptor may have dimensions of about 1.5 inches x about 0.75 inch x about 6 inches.
- the network adaptor fits in at least a portion of a window framing (e.g., mullions and/or transoms), wall, floor and/or other building structure. It may directly connect to one or more cables (e.g., wires) providing electrical power and data and/or cellular communications, e.g., from a headend or control panel. It may connect to windows or any other target.
- the target may comprise an Internet of Things (loT) device such as a digital architectural element.
- the control panel can comprise a circuitry disposed on one or more electronic boards. The control panel may comprise connection to electrical and/or optical wiring.
- the control panel, device ensemble, edge distribution frame, and/or switch may each be housed in a housing.
- the housing may comprise a transparent or non-transparent portion.
- the housing may comprise a hardened material (e.g., elemental mental, metal alloy, polymer, resin, glass, or an allotrope of elemental carbon).
- the housing may comprise a composite material.
- the housing may have one or more perforations.
- the housing may have a window and/or door.
- the housing may have a cover. The cover can be (e.g., reversibly) snapped to the body of the housing.
- the network adapter includes frequency shifting capabilities.
- the network adapter may transmit and/or receive signals over a (e.g., coaxial) cable, which signals have been frequency shifted.
- An interface, controller, or other element (i) may shift signals being transmitted out of the network adapter and/or (ii) may reverse the shift for signals coming into the network adapter over the network bus (e.g., branch circuit).
- the network bus e.g., branch circuit
- control related signals and/or media related signals may be overlapping when unshifted, and may be non-overlapping when shifted by network components such as the network adapter, distribution junction, and/or control panel (e.g., headend) that have frequency shifting capability.
- network components such as the network adapter, distribution junction, and/or control panel (e.g., headend) that have frequency shifting capability.
- Fig. 6 shows an example of a network adapter 600.
- a connector (not shown) taps to a (e.g., coaxial) cable 605 (e.g., network bus) having a grounded sheath and an internal conductor. Electrical power and data may be carried by the (e.g., coaxial) cable.
- a connector to a (e.g., coaxial) cable is described herein (see, e.g., the discussion of distribution junction 310 of Fig. 3).
- connectors are provided for delivering electrical power and data to (i) a connector 619 and (ii) a local controller 621 .
- the connector 619 provides power and data transmission capabilities.
- the connector 619 can be an Ethernet connector, with Power over Ethernet capabilities.
- the connector 619 can provide 100Base Ethernet and/or 1000Base Ethernet connectivity.
- the connector 619 may be an RJ45 connector.
- the connector 621 can be configured to couple to a target such as an optically switchable window (e.g., an IGU with one or more electrochromic devices disposed on one or more of the lites of the IGU).
- the connector 619 can be a (e.g., coaxial) cable connector (e.g., RG- designated connect or a BNC-designated connector).
- Electrical (e.g., DC) power from the (e.g., coaxial) cable is split at point 629.
- the electrical power then passes through an inductor choke 607 and onto line (e.g., cable(s)) 609.
- the inductor choke 607 allows DC electrical current to pass while attenuating (e.g., blocking) time-varying communication signal components (e.g., control related data, media related data, and/or antenna signals).
- Some of the DC current on line 609 is provided to DC/DC converter 611 (also referred to as a DC-to-DC converter).
- DC/DC converter 611 is configured to provide DC power at a configured voltage for internal operation of the network adapter.
- the DC power may be used by one or more processors and other targets (e.g., elements) within, or coupled to, the network adaptor, including PoE power injection circuit 617, local (e.g. , window) controller 621 , interface 623, (e.g. , ethernet) controller 625, and processor 627.
- processors and other targets e.g., elements
- PoE power injection circuit 617 local (e.g. , window) controller 621 , interface 623, (e.g. , ethernet) controller 625, and processor 627.
- DC/DC converter 613 may be a (e.g., 48V) restore circuit.
- DC/DC converter 613 is configured to alter (e.g., boost or reduce (as appropriate)) the DC voltage received from line (e.g., cable) 605 to a designated voltage (e.g., 48 volts).
- Inductor 615 is coupled between DC/DC converter 613 and Power over the Ethernet circuit. Inductor 615 smooths out DC voltages provided by DC/DC converter 613 and attenuates (e.g., blocks) time-varying signals from flowing towards DC/DC converter 613.
- the network adaptor 600 is configured such that electrical current on the leg containing the designated voltage (e.g., 48 volts) restore circuit - DC/DC converter 613 - and inductor 615 is delivered to a Power over Ethernet circuit 617 configured to make electrical power available for transmission on physical lines (e.g., that can carry Ethernet formatted data). Power over Ethernet circuit 617 is electrically connected to connector 619 in a manner allowing delivery of electrical current at a designated voltage (e.g., 48 volts) to one or more end devices that connect to connector 619.
- a designated voltage e.g., 48 volts
- Interface 623 Downstream from point 629 is an interface 623 bidirectionally coupled to line (e.g., coaxial cable) 605.
- Interface 623 is configured to encode and decode data according to the communication (e.g., G.hn or MoCA) protocol.
- Interface 623 is configured to (i) decode or otherwise interpret communication (e.g., G.hn) data received from line (e.g., coaxial cable) 605, and (ii) encode or otherwise format data.
- the data (A) is provided via controller 625 and/or 621 , and/or (B) is generated internally (e.g., by processor 627 and/or by a local (e.g., window) controller 621), using the communication protocol signal (e.g., G.hn) for upstream transmission via the line (e.g., coaxial cable) 605.
- the communication protocol signal e.g., G.hn
- An (e.g., ethernet) controller 625 is bidirectionally coupled to the communication (e.g., G.hn) interface 623. (e.g., Ethernet) controller 625 is bidirectionally coupled to connector 619. (e.g., Ethernet) controller 625 is configured to provide data in an appropriate physical layer format for subsequent transmission such as Ethernet transmission.
- controller 625 may be configured to decode Ethernet data from connector 619 (e.g., from end nodes) and/or provide the unencoded data to communication (e.g., G.hn) interface 623 for subsequent upstream transmission (e.g., Ethernet) controller 625 may be configured to (i) receive data from interface 623, (ii) encode the data in an Ethernet physical layer format, and (iii) provide the encoded data to connector 619.
- Ethernet controller 625 may provide data in a physical layer format suitable for transmission to end nodes (e.g. Ethernet nodes).
- a processor 627 (e.g., comprising a microprocessor) is bidirectionally coupled to the communication (e.g., G.hn) interface 623 and to PoE circuit 617.
- Processor 627 may be configured to provide any one or more of various functions for nodes connected to connector 619 and/or local (e.g., window) controller 621 . Examples of such functions include sensor data interpretation, tint commands for electrochromic windows, negotiation of power delivery (e.g., over connector 619), and any combination thereof.
- microprocessor 627 is configured to provide computing capabilities for a device such as sensor, emitter, or any other device disclosed herein (e.g., loT (Internet of Things) functionality such as that of a digital architectural element).
- processor 627 can be configured to limit electrical power consumption by an end device through connector 619, e.g., to a predetermined electrical power limit (the power limit may be of at most about 1 watt, 5 watt, or 10 watts).
- Limiting to a predetermined power limit may be at least until a higher level of power consumption is negotiated with (e.g., and approved by) processor 627 and/or by a control panel. Following negotiation of power consumption, the processor 627 may permit the end device to exceed the predetermined limit and/or to consume the negotiated amount of power.
- power over Ethernet circuit 617 is bidirectionally coupled to connector 619 for sending and/or receiving data.
- Power over Ethernet circuit 617 is coupled to processor 627, thereby allowing direct and/or indirect bidirectional communication between end nodes (e.g., targets) coupled to 619 and processor 627.
- Network adaptor 600 is configured to make processing resources (of processor 627) available to downstream nodes.
- An optional local (e.g., window) controller 621 is bidirectionally coupled to microprocessor 627 and cable 622 (e.g., window cable).
- local (e.g., window) controller 621 is configured to perform some or all functions of a window controller (also referred to herein as a local controller).
- local controller 621 is a window controller that is configured to receive tint transition instructions from the control panel, generate and provide (i) tint transition voltage and/or current profiles to electrochromic devices, (ii) receive and/or process sensor readings, and/or (iii) receive current and/or voltage readings from electrochromic devices.
- Examples of functions of a local (e.g., window) controller are provided in US Published Patent Applications (1) 13/449,248, filed April 17, 2012 titled “CONTROLLER FOR OPTICALLY-SWITCHABLE WINDOWS;” (2) 13/449,251 , filed April 17, 2012 titled “CONTROLLER FOR OPTICALLY-SWITCHABLE WINDOWS;” (3) 15/334,835, filed October 26, 2016 titled “CONTROLLERS FOR OPTICALLY-SWITCHABLE DEVICES;” and (4) 15/334,832, filed October 26, 2016 titled “CONTROLLERS FOR OPTICALLY-SWITCHABLE DEVICES;” each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- control one or more panels are provided that serve as distribution hubs.
- a control panel may provide one or more links to other control panel(s) in a building’s (e.g., vertical and/or horizontal) data plane.
- a control panel may include a network switch, such an Ethernet switch, configured to communicate between control panels.
- the control panels can be disposed in the same floor on in different floors.
- a network switch may be configured to communicate between control panels on different floors of a building.
- control panels may comprise network switches configured to provide network communications (e.g., Ethernet communications) at data rates of at least about 100 Megabits/second (Mbit/s), 500Mbit/s, 1 Gigabit/second (Gbit/s), or 10 Gbit/s, between control panels (e.g., disposed within a floor and/or between floors).
- network communications e.g., Ethernet communications
- Mbit/s Megabits/second
- Gbit/s 1 Gigabit/second
- 10 Gbit/s Gigabit/second
- control panel there is at least one control panel on each of at least two different floors of a building. In some cases, there is at least one control panel on every floor of a building. In some cases, there are at least two control panels on at least one floor of a building. In certain embodiments, there are fewer than one control panel per floor of a building (e.g., at least one floor of a building is devoid of a control panel). In certain embodiments, a control panel is located in an elevator pier area or another area (e.g., pier) having a dedicated mechanical and/or electrical controls and/or other infrastructure (e.g., an electrical closet with circuit breakers).
- control panel(s) on the floor(s) are connected to a main controller.
- the main controller can be disposed in the building.
- the main controller can be disposed in a basement of the building, or in some dedicated region of a building (e.g., a ground floor or uppermost floor).
- the main controller can be a primary control panel.
- the primary control panel may have more computing resources (e.g., processing capability and memory and storage capabilities) than the other control panels in the control system (e.g., than any other control panel in the control system).
- the primary control panel is networked with the remainder of the control panels in a redundant fashion (e.g., with two or more optical fibers) such that failure of a single link does not result in the disconnection of any control panels from the network.
- the primary control panel has a wired and/or wireless connection to a cellular network, a backhaul network, an internet, an extranet, and/or a network that is in communication with the Internet.
- the main controller is located externally to the building. In some embodiments, the main controller is located in the cloud.
- a control panel may include a gateway to a horizontal data plane.
- a control panel is configured to communicate with nodes on horizontal data plane a via (e.g., coaxial) cable.
- a control panel is configured to communicate with nodes on horizontal data plane a via (e.g., twisted pair copper) cable.
- the control panel may be configured to implement a linear, star, or circular network topology.
- the control panel may be configured to implement point to multipoint communications.
- the control panel may be configured to communicate with one or more targets (e.g., nodes) on a horizontal and/or vertical data plane using a particular physical and/or link layer protocol (such as G.hn protocol and/or MoCA).
- G.hn protocol may allow the transmission of data over any wire medium. Data rates within the G.hn protocol may be in the range of from about 100 megabit/sec up to about 1 .7 Gb/sec.
- the G.hn protocol may utilize signals from about 2 MHz to about 200 MHz.
- the G.hn protocol, as implemented herein, may be tolerate of cables with imperfections (e.g., such as those created by tapping bus lines to branch lines, such as via a distribution junction).
- the control panel comprises at least one communication headend.
- the control panel may include MoCA and/or G.hn headends.
- the headend may be configured to determine physical topology of the horizontal and/or vertical data plane based at least in part upon the profile of the (e.g., electrical) power spectrum provided at the headend. Notches in the power spectrum may be produced by nodes on the network. The size and location of the notches on the power spectrum may correspond to the physical topology of the network served by the headend.
- a communication (e.g., G.hn) headend may be configured to identify the portion of its allocated frequency spectrum to use for communications, e.g., so as not to accidentally use low power portions of the spectrum.
- communication (e.g., G.hn) data is transmitted in point to multipoint fashion on a horizontal and/or vertical data plane.
- a master the G.hn headend
- slave nodes end nodes on the horizontal and/or vertical data plane.
- slave nodes do not communicate directly to each other.
- slave nodes do communicate directly among themselves.
- the (e.g., horizontal) data plane infrastructure including, e.g., a control panel, cabling such as coaxial cables, and network adaptors is used to provide electrical power to nodes on the network.
- electrical power e.g., provided at about 48 volts DC
- the control panel includes a power manager.
- the power manager may be configured to control distribution of power to individual network adaptors and/or end nodes on a network.
- the individual network adaptors or other nodes may be provided power according to a protocol implemented in the power manager.
- the end nodes will not be permitted to draw power whenever they want to.
- Various criteria may be employed to decide when and/or how much electrical power to deliver to individual nodes or network adaptors on a network. Such criteria may include, for example, ensuring that the total delivered power on the system does not exceed some threshold, such as a threshold set for a particular electrical standard in the jurisdiction (e.g., 100 W for class 2 networks in the United States).
- some threshold such as a threshold set for a particular electrical standard in the jurisdiction (e.g., 100 W for class 2 networks in the United States).
- one or more end nodes connected to the network are not permitted to draw power (or permitted to draw only a limited amount of power) until they have negotiated with the power manager for power.
- the power manager, or another network component may form a virtual network with the end nodes for the purposes of power negotiation and/or network authentication.
- a power management protocol employs a defined set of communications between the power manager and one or more network adaptors or nodes. For examples, requests for power may be issued by network adaptors and requests for information may be issued by a power manager. Data containing the timing and/or conditions of power delivery, may be issued from the power manager before power is actually delivered. In certain embodiments, such communications are provided using the (e.g., G.hn) communications protocol. Power over Ethernet may be implemented with its own protocol. In certain embodiments, a link layer discovery protocol (LLDP) is employed to provide the relevant communications for power management, whether or not using a Power over Ethernet protocol.
- LLDP link layer discovery protocol
- Fig. 7 depicts an example of a control panel 700.
- Control panel 700 includes a pair of switches 701 and 702.
- the switches 701 and 702 are coupled to optical fibers 710.
- the optical fibers 710 can connect to other control panels in the network (which are on the same or on other floors of the building).
- the optical fibers 710 can include fibers such as 204, 213, 215, and 217 of Fig. 2, as examples.
- the switches 701 and 702 are also coupled to ethernet cables 712. Ethernet cables 712 are coupled to devices (e.g., disposed on the floor of control panel 700) and control components within the control panel 700.
- Control panel 700 further includes a floor controller 703.
- the floor controller 703 can control a plurality of local (e.g., window and/or sensor) controllers (see, e.g., the discussion of network controllers 106 of Fig. 1).
- Control panel 700 further includes first and second communication (abbreviated in Fig. 7 as “comm.” e.g., G.hn) head-ends 704 and 705.
- Communication head ends 704 and 705 are coupled to a plurality of network bus cables 714, which may be coaxial cables.
- the communication head ends 704 and 705 may provide electrical (e.g., DC) power and multiple distinguishable time-varying signals (e.g., simultaneously) over the network bus cables 714.
- the network bus cables include (e.g., coaxial) power and/or communication cables 259, 261 , and 263 of Fig. 2, as examples.
- the communication head ends 704 and 705 may include, as examples, a pre-amplifier and/or an amplifier.
- Control panel 700 further includes electrical power distribution unit (PDU) 706.
- PDU 706 may serve as a network-connected power strip.
- Control components within control panel 700 including switches 701 and 702, floor controller 703, and/or communication headends 704 and 705, may receive power through PDU 706.
- PDU 706 may provide remote network-based monitoring of power usage by connected targets (e.g., devices).
- PDU 706 may provide remote network-based control of (e.g., electronic) power distribution to individual powered targets (e.g., components).
- PDU 706 can be used to remotely turn on and turn off, individually or in any combination, the various targets (e.g., components) receiving power through 706.
- an enclosure e.g., a building
- An edge distribution frame may include one or more antennas, modems, and/or one or more radios configured to provide wireless communications connectivity to at least a portion of the enclosure.
- An edge distribution frame (abbreviated herein as “EDF”) may be coupled to a control panel (e.g., a control panel on a respective floor).
- the edge distribution frame may be in electrical and/or data communication with the control panel.
- one or more (e.g., combined) cables may be provided that include current conductor(s) communication cable(s) and/or one or more optical fibers.
- the current conductor may convey electrical power (e.g., from the control panel to the edge distribution frames).
- the current conductors communication cable(s) and/or the optical fiber(s) may convey analog signals and/or digital data between the control panels and the edge distribution frame(s).
- the edge distribution frame(s) may provide wireless communications capabilities (e.g., comprising cellular communications and/or Wi-Fi®) in their adjacent vicinities.
- the edge distribution frames may form a network (e.g., on some or all of the floors of a building) that may overlap with other cabling networks (e.g., coaxial-cable containing wiring networks that provide wired and/or wireless connectivity).
- Fig. 8 depicts an example of an enclosure 800 (e.g., a floor of a building) that includes a network of edge distribution frames (EDFs).
- EDFs edge distribution frames
- a network of EDFs 802a-e may be distributed across an enclosure (e.g., a floor of a building).
- the EDFs 802a-e may include antennas, modem, and/or radios and may provide wireless connectivity (e.g., cellular and/or Wi-Fi® connectivity) to detect signal from most (e.g., all) of the floor of the building.
- the EDFs 802a-e may be in electrical and/or data communication with control panel 800.
- EDFs 802a-e are coupled to the control panel 850 via respective cables 802a-e.
- the links (e.g., cables) 804a-e can be combination cables that include current carrying conductors and data communication (e.g., a coaxial cable or a combination of cables with one or more optical fibers), thus providing electrical power and data connectivity to the EDFs 802a-e.
- the enclosure includes other cabling networks, that may include coaxial-cable-based networks.
- the enclosure includes (e.g., coaxial) cables 806a-c, which provide connectivity to end targets (e.g., devices 808).
- the (e.g., coaxial) cables 806a-c are dispersed throughout at least some (e.g., all) of the enclosure and their reception zone overlaps in space with a portion of service areas of the EDFs 802a-e.
- Fig. 8 depicts a remote radio head (RRH) 810.
- the remote radio head may, as an example, be a cellular antenna or radio mounted to an exterior of the enclosure. The remote radio head can thereby provide connectivity to networks external to the enclosure.
- the RRH 810 can be connected to the control panel 850 via ID 812 and link (e.g., cable) 814.
- Link (e.g., cable) 814 may be a combined cable including current carrying conductors and/or communication transmitting cables such as coaxial cables or optical fibers.
- ID 812 may include radios, amplifiers, pre-amplifiers, switches, and/or other network devices supporting RRH 810.
- a communications network for a building may include a vertically-oriented network portion (e.g., vertical data planes) that connects network components on multiple floors.
- the network components may include control panels disposed on separate floors, and a vertical data plane may connect the control panels together with redundancy.
- a vertically-oriented network 900 having redundancy is shown in Fig. 9.
- control panels 901a-901d are each located on a different floor of a building, which control panels are redundantly interconnected.
- control panel 901a is connected to control panels 901b and 901 d
- control panel 901b is connected to control panels 901a and 901c
- control panel 901c is connected to control panels 901 d and 901b
- control panel 901 d is connected to control panels 901a and 901c.
- Some or all of the connections between control panels are themselves redundant (e.g., are formed from a pair of optical fibers (or other cabling medium)).
- the network 900 also includes a cell modem 902, which connects the network to an external cellular network.
- the network 900 includes redundant connections to infrastructure 904 (e.g., another network, whether internal or external to the enclosure in which network 900 is disposed).
- a network may have multiple control panels on a plurality of building floors.
- a single floor may have horizontal data planes (e.g., networks of coaxial bus lines and edge data frames) served by two or more control panels.
- An example of such an arrangement is shown in Fig. 10.
- a first floor of a building includes control panels 1001a and 1001b, which are coupled together with a pair of lines (e.g., optical fibers), to provide redundancy.
- a second floor of a building includes control panels 1001 c and 1001 d
- a third floor of a building includes control panels 1001 e and 1001 f
- a fourth floor of a building includes control panels 1001 g and 1001 h.
- the control panels 1001a-h are coupled to infrastructure 1004 (e.g., another network, whether internal or external to the enclosure in which network 1000 is disposed).
- infrastructure 1004 e.g., another network, whether internal or external to the enclosure in which network 1000 is disposed.
- a first set of control panels e.g., comprising control panels 1001a, 1001c, 1001e, and 1001 g
- a second set of control panels e.g., comprising control panels 1001b, 1001 d, 1001 f, and 1001 h
- form a second vertically-oriented network having redundant connections as illustrated.
- One benefit of having the vertical connections arranged in the manner of Fig. 10 is that the connections of the two sets of control panels can be run in separate risers within the building.
- FIG. 11 A shows an example in which control panel panels 1101 a-d are connected together using redundant loops. In particular, there are two vertical links between control panels on adjacent floors as well as two vertical links between the control panels on the top and bottom floors. Additionally, control panel 1101a is redundantly connected to infrastructure 1104 (e.g., another network, whether internal or external to the enclosure in which network 900 is disposed).
- infrastructure 1104 e.g., another network, whether internal or external to the enclosure in which network 900 is disposed.
- a first floor of a building includes control panels 1101a
- a second floor of a building includes control panels 1101b
- a third floor of a building includes control panels 1101c
- a fourth floor of a building includes control panels 1101 d.
- Fig. 11 B shows an example in which each floor of the building includes two control panels and there are two redundant loops in the vertical data plane.
- control panel panels 1102a-d are connected together in a first redundant loop while control panel panels 1102e-h are connected together in a second redundant loop.
- a first floor of a building includes control panels 1102a and 1102e
- a second floor of a building includes control panels 1102b and 1102f
- a third floor of a building includes control panels 1102c and 1102g
- a fourth floor of a building includes control panels 1102d and 1102h.
- Control panels 1102a-d are redundantly connected to infrastructure 1104.
- Control panels 1102e-h are redundantly connected to infrastructure 1104.
- Control panels 1102e-h are redundantly connected to control panels 1102a-d.
- Fig. 11C shows an example in which each floor of the building includes two control panels, there is one redundant loop in the vertical data lane, and there is a redundant loop in some (e.g., all) of the floors of the building.
- control panels 1103a-d are connected together in redundant loop in the vertical data plane.
- control panel pairs 1103a and 1103e, 1103b and 1103f , 1103c and 1103g, and 1103d and 1103h are connected together in respective redundant loops in the horizontal data plane.
- a first floor of a building includes control panels 1103a and 1103e, a second floor of a building includes control panels 1103b and 1103f, a third floor of a building includes control panels 1103c and 1103g, and a fourth floor of a building includes control panels 1103d and 1103h.
- Control panel 1102a is redundantly connected to both control panel 1103e and infrastructure 1104;
- control panel 1103b is redundantly connected to both control panel 1103f and infrastructure 1104;
- control panel 1103c is redundantly connected to both control panel 1103g and infrastructure 1104;
- control panel 1103d is redundantly connected to both control panel 1103h and infrastructure 1104.
- a network infrastructure supports a control system for one or more windows such as electrochromic (e.g., tintable) windows.
- the control system may comprise one or more controllers operatively coupled (e.g., directly or indirectly) to one or more windows.
- electrochromic windows also referred to herein as “optically switchable windows,” “tintable windows”, or “smart windows”
- the concepts disclosed herein may apply to other types of switchable optical devices including, for example, a liquid crystal device, or a suspended particle device.
- a liquid crystal device and/or a suspended particle device may be implemented instead of, or in addition to, an electrochromic device.
- a tintable exhibits a (e.g., controllable and/or reversible) change in at least one optical property of the window, e.g., when a stimulus is applied.
- the stimulus can include an optical, electrical and/or magnetic stimulus.
- the stimulus can include an applied voltage.
- One or more tintable windows can be used to control lighting and/or glare conditions, e.g., by regulating the transmission of solar energy propagating through them.
- One or more tintable windows can be used to control a temperature within a building, e.g., by regulating the transmission of solar energy propagating through them. Control of the solar energy may control heat load imposed on the interior of the facility (e.g., building).
- the control may be manual and/or automatic.
- the control may be used for maintaining one or more requested (e.g., environmental) conditions, e.g., occupant comfort.
- the control may include reducing energy consumption of a heating, ventilation, air conditioning and/or lighting systems. At least two of heating, ventilation, and air conditioning may be induced by separate systems. At least two of heating, ventilation, and air conditioning may be induced by one system.
- the heating, ventilation, and air conditioning may be induced by a single system (abbreviated herein as “HVAC).
- tintable windows may be responsive to one or more environmental sensors and/or user control. Tintable windows may comprise (e.g, may be) electrochromic windows.
- Tintable windows may operate using liquid crystal devices, suspended particle devices, microelectromechanical systems (MEMS) devices (such as microshutters), or any technology known now, or later developed, that is configured to control light transmission through a window.
- MEMS microelectromechanical systems
- Windows with MEMS devices for tinting are described in U.S. Patent Application Serial Number 14/443,353 that was filed May 15, 2015, and titled “MULTI-PANE WINDOWS INCLUDING ELECTROCHROMIC DEVICES AND ELECTROMECHANICAL SYSTEMS DEVICES,” which is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety.
- one or more tintable windows can be located within the interior of a building, e.g., between a conference room and a hallway. In some cases, one or more tintable windows can be used in automobiles, trains, aircraft, and other vehicles, e.g., in lieu of a passive and/or non-tinting window.
- the tintable window comprises an electrochromic device (referred to herein as an “EC device” (abbreviated herein as ECD), or “EC”).
- An EC device may comprise at least one coating that includes at least one layer.
- the at least one layer can comprise an electrochromic material.
- the electrochromic material exhibits a change from one optical state to another, e.g., when an electric potential is applied across the EC device.
- the transition of the electrochromic layer from one optical state to another optical state can be caused, e.g., by reversible, semi-reversible, or irreversible ion insertion into the electrochromic material (e.g., by way of intercalation) and a corresponding injection of charge-balancing electrons.
- the transition of the electrochromic layer from one optical state to another optical state can be caused, e.g., by a reversible ion insertion into the electrochromic material (e.g., by way of intercalation) and a corresponding injection of charge-balancing electrons.
- Reversible may be for the expected lifetime of the ECD.
- Semi-reversible refers to a measurable (e.g.
- a fraction of the ions responsible for the optical transition is irreversibly bound up in the electrochromic material (e.g., and thus the induced (altered) tint state of the window is not reversible to its original tinting state).
- at least some (e.g., all) of the irreversibly bound ions can be used to compensate for “blind charge” in the material (e.g., ECD).
- suitable ions include cations.
- the cations may include lithium ions (Li+) and/or hydrogen ions (H+) (i.e., protons).
- other ions can be suitable.
- Intercalation of the cations may be into an (e.g., metal) oxide.
- a change in the intercalation state of the ions (e.g. cations) into the oxide may induce a visible change in a tint (e.g., color) of the oxide.
- the oxide may transition from a colorless to a colored state.
- intercalation of lithium ions into tungsten oxide may cause the tungsten oxide to change from a transparent state to a colored (e.g., blue) state.
- EC device coatings as described herein are located within the viewable portion of the tintable window such that the tinting of the EC device coating can be used to control the optical state of the tintable window.
- an EC device coating may include one or more additional layers such as one or more passive layers. Passive layers can be used to improve certain optical properties, to provide moisture, and/or to provide scratch resistance. These and/or other passive layers can serve to hermetically seal the EC stack (e.g, 1220). Various layers, including transparent conducting layers, can be treated with anti-reflective and/or protective layers (e.g., oxide and/or nitride layers).
- the electrochromic device is configured to (e.g., substantially) reversibly cycle between a clear state and a tinted state. Reversible may be within an expected lifetime of the ECD.
- the expected lifetime can be at least about 5, 10, 15, 25, 50, 75, or 100 years.
- the expected lifetime can be any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 5 years to about 100 years, from about 5 years to about 50 years, or from about 50 years to about 100 years).
- a potential can be applied to the electrochromic stack such that available ions in the stack that can cause the electrochromic material to be in the tinted state reside primarily in the counter electrode when the window is in a first tint state (e.g., clear).
- a first tint state e.g., clear
- the reference to a transition between a clear state and tinted state is non-limiting and suggests only one example, among many, of an electrochromic transition that may be implemented. Unless otherwise specified herein, whenever reference is made to a clear-tinted transition, the corresponding device or process encompasses other optical state transitions such as non-reflective-reflective, and/or transparent-opaque.
- the terms “clear” and “bleached” refer to an optically neutral state, e.g., untinted, transparent and/or translucent.
- the “color” or “tint” of an electrochromic transition is not limited to any wavelength or range of wavelengths. The choice of appropriate electrochromic material and counter electrode materials may govern the relevant optical transition (e.g., from tinted to untinted state).
- At least a portion (e.g., all of) the materials making up electrochromic stack are inorganic, solid (e.g., in the solid state), or both inorganic and solid. Because various organic materials tend to degrade over time, particularly when exposed to heat and UV light as tinted building windows are, inorganic materials offer an advantage of a reliable electrochromic stack that can function for extended periods of time. In some embodiments, materials in the solid state can offer the advantage of being minimally contaminated and minimizing leakage issues, as materials in the liquid state sometimes do. One or more of the layers in the stack may contain some amount of organic material (e.g., that is measurable).
- the ECD or any portion thereof may contain little or no measurable organic matter.
- the ECD or any portion thereof may contain one or more liquids that may be present in little amounts. Little may be of at most about 100ppm, 10ppm, or 1ppm of the ECD.
- Solid state material may be deposited (or otherwise formed) using one or more processes employing liquid components, such as certain processes employing sol-gels, physical vapor deposition, and/or chemical vapor deposition.
- an IGU includes two (or more) substantially transparent substrates.
- the IGU may include two panes of glass. At least one substrate of the IGU can include an electrochromic device disposed thereon. The one or more panes of the IGU may have a separator disposed between them.
- An IGU can be a hermetically sealed construct, e.g., having an interior region that is isolated from the ambient environment.
- a “window assembly” may include an IGU.
- a “window assembly” may include a (e.g., standalone) laminate.
- a “window assembly” may include one or more electrical leads, e.g., for connecting the IGUs and/or laminates. The electricl leads may operatively couple (e.g. connect) one or more electrochromic devices to a voltage source, switches and the like, and may include a frame that supports the IGU or laminate.
- a window assembly may include a window controller, and/or components of a window controller (e.g., a dock).
- the first pane, the second panes, and/or the IGU is a rectangular solid. In some implementations, other (e.g., geometric) shapes are possible.
- the shape of the first pane, the second panes, and/or the IGU can include circular, elliptical, triangular, curvilinear, convex and/or concave.
- the the first pane, the second panes, and/or the IGU may include a curvature.
- the first pane, the second panes, and/or the IGU may be devoid of a curvature.
- the the first pane, the second panes, and/or the IGU may include one or more straight edge portions.
- a fundamental length scale of a pane may be at least 1 feet(ft), 2ft, 3ft, 5ft, 10 ft, 20 ft, 30 ft, 40 ft, 50 ft, 60 ft, 80 ft, or 100ft.
- a FLS of a pane may be of any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 1ft to about 100 ft, from about 1 ft to about 60ft, or from about 50ft to about 100ft).
- a fundamental length scale (abbreviated herein as “FLS”) may comprise a length, a width, or a diameter of a bounding circle.
- a length “L” of the first and/or the second panes can be in the range of at least about 20 inches (in.) to at most about 10 feet (ft.).
- a width “W” of the first and/or the second panes can be in the range of from about 20 in. to about 10 ft.
- a thickness of a pane may be at least about 0.1 millimeter (mm), 0.2mm, 0.3mm, 0.4mm, 0.5 mm, 1 mm, 5mm, 10mm, 20mm, or 50mm .
- a thickness of a pane may be of any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 0.1mm to about 50mm, from about 0.1mm to about 1 mm, from about 0.5mm to about 20mm, or from about 10mm to about 50mm).
- a thickness “T” of of the first and/or the second panes can be in the range of from about 0.3 millimeters (mm) to about 10 mm.
- Other FLS e.g., lengths, or widths
- thicknesses both smaller and larger, may be possible (e.g., requested) based at least in part on the needs of a particular user, manager, administrator, builder, architect, and/or owner.
- the substrate may be laminated, e.g., to an additional substrate.
- the additional substrate may be thicker.
- the additional substrate may protect the thin substrate.
- the IGU can include two panes, in some implementations, an IGU can include three or more panes. In some implementations, one or more of the panes can be a laminate structure of two, three, or more layers (or sub-panes).
- first and second panes are spaced apart from one another by at least one spacer, e.g., to form an interior volume.
- the spacer(s) can comprise a frame structure.
- the interior volume is filled with a gas (e.g., Argon (Ar)).
- the interior volume can be filled with another gas, such as another noble gas (e.g., krypton (Kr), xenon (Xn)), another (non-noble) gas), a non-reactive gas (e.g., nitrogen), or mixture of gases (e.g., air). Filling the interior volume with the gas(es) can reduce conductive heat transfer through the IGU.
- the gas(es) may have a low thermal conductivity.
- the gas(es) may improve acoustic insulation.
- the gas(es) may have an increased atomic weights with respect to gas(es) in the ambient environment (e.g., air).
- the interior volume can be evacuated of gas(es).
- the interior volume may comprise a reduced pressure as compared to an ambient pressure.
- the interior volume may have a gas composition and/or pressure different than the one in the ambient environment (e.g., external to the IGU).
- the one or more spacers may determine (at least in part) the height of the interior volume (e.g., 1308); that is, the extent of spacing between the first and the second panes.
- the FLS of the spacer may be at least about 4 mm, 5 mm, 6 mm, 10 mm, 20 mm, 25 mm, 30 mm, 35 mm, or 40mm.
- the FLS of the spacer may have any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 4 mm to about 25 mm, from about 20 mm to about 40 mm, or from about 4 mm to about 40mm).
- the spacing between the first and the second panes is in the range of from about 6 mm to about 30 mm.
- the width (e.g., “D” in Fig. 2A) of spacer can be in the range of from about 5 mm to about 25 mm (although other widths are possible and may be desirable).
- the at least one spacer can be a frame structure formed around a plurality of (e.g., all) sides of the IGU (for example, top, bottom, left and right sides of the IGU).
- the spacer can be formed of a foam and/or plastic material.
- the spacer may comprise a polymer.
- the spacer can comprise an elemental metal or a metal alloy.
- the spacer may comprise a tube or a channel structure.
- the spacer may have at least 3 sides.
- the spacer may have at least two sides (e.g., configurd for sealing to each of the lites).
- the spacer may have one at least side configured to support and/or separate the lites.
- the spacer may have at least one side configured to supports a surface on which to apply a sealant (e.g., between the spacer and the lite).
- a first primary seal may adhere to the spacer.
- the first primary seal may hermetically seals the spacer and the second surface (e.g., S2 of Fig. 13) of the first pane (e.g., 1304).
- a second primary seal may adhere to and/or hermetically seal the spacer and the first surface (e.g., S3 of Fig. 13) of the second pane (e.g., 1306).
- the primary seals can comprise an adhesive sealant such as, for example, polyisobutylene (PIB).
- the IGU includes a secondary seal that (e.g., hermetically) seals a border around the IGU.
- the secondary seal may be disposed outside of spacer.
- the spacer can be inset from edges of the first and second panes, e.g., by a distance that can be in the range of from about 4 mm to about 8 mm (although other distances are possible and may be desirable).
- secondary seal can comprise an adhesive sealant such as, for example, a polymeric material.
- the spacer material may resist water.
- the spacer material may add structural support to the assembly.
- the spacer material may comprise silicone, polyurethane, Teflon, or structural sealants that form a watertight seal.
- one or more controllers are operatively coupled to the window.
- One or more controllers can be associated with (e.g., operatively coupled to) one or more tintable windows.
- the one or more controllers can be configured to control an optical state of the window, e.g., by applying a stimulus to the window.
- the stimulus may comprise a voltage and/or a current, e.g., to an EC device coating.
- the one or more controllers may have various sizes, formats, and locations with respect to the optically switchable windows they control.
- the at least one controller may be attached to a lite of an IGU or laminate thereof.
- the at least one controller may be disposed in a frame, e.g., that houses the IGU or laminate.
- the at least one controller may be disposed in a location separate from the IGU (or laminate thereof).
- a tintable window may include one, two, three or more electrochromic panes (e.g., an electrochromic device on a transparent substrate).
- An individual pane of an electrochromic window may include an electrochromic coating, e.g., that has independently tintable zones.
- the at least one controller can control at least two of (e.g., all of) the electrochromic coatings associated with the window(s), whether the electrochromic coating is monolithic or zoned.
- the window controller is located in proximity to the tintable window (e.g., when not directly, attached to a tintable window, IGU, or frame).
- a window controller may be adjacent to the window, on the surface of one of the lites of the window, within a wall next to a window (e.g., a wall bordering and/or contacting the window), or within a frame of a window assembly.
- the window controller is an in situ controller.
- an in situ controller is is part of a window assembly (e.g., comprising an IGU or a laminate). The in situ controller may not have to be matched with the electrochromic window.
- the in situ controller may be installed, in the field (e.g., target location).
- the in situ controler may travel with the window (e.g., as part of the assembly) from the factory.
- the in situ controller may be installed in the window frame of a window assembly, and/or be part of an IGU (and/or laminate) assembly.
- the controller can be mounted on to, or between, panes of the IGU.
- the controller can be disposed on a pane of a laminate.
- the controller may be controller located on the visible portion of an IGU. At least a portion of the controller may be (e.g., substantially) transparent to an average human eye. Further examples of controllers are provided in U.S.
- a localized controller may be provided (i) as more than one part (e.g., portion), (ii) with at least one part (e.g., including a memory component storing information about the associated electrochromic window), (iii) as a part of the window assembly, and/or (iv) with at least one portion thereof being separate.
- the controller may be configured to mate with the at least one portion of the window assembly, IGU, and/or laminate.
- a controller may be an assembly of interconnected parts. The interconnected parts may not be disposed in a single housing.
- the interconnected parts of hte controller may be disposed as spaced apart, (e.g., in the secondary seal of an IGU).
- the controller can constitute a compact unit.
- the compact unit may be in a single housing.
- the compact unit may reside in two or more separate components that combine (e.g., a dock and housing assembly).
- the controller may be disposed in an area that is viewable or not viewable by an occupant of an enclosure in which the controller resides.
- the window controller is incorporated into or onto (i) the IGU and/or (ii) the window frame.
- the incorporation of the controller may be prior to, during, and/or after installation of the tintable window in its target location.
- the controller e.g., of the window
- the controller may be disposed in the same facility (e.g., building) as the window.
- the controller can be incorporated into or onto the IGU and/or the window frame, prior to leaving the manufacturing facility of the window and/or of the controller.
- the controller is incorporated into the IGU (e.g., substantially within the secondary seal).
- the controller is incorporated into or onto the IGU, partially, substantially, or wholly within a perimeter defined by the primary seal. The perimeter may be between the sealing separator and the substrate (e.g., lite).
- the controller may be part of an IGU and/or a window assembly.
- the controller may travel with the IGU or window unit.
- the IGU can possess logic and features of the controller.
- one or more characteristics of the electrochromic device(s) change over time (e.g., through degradation).
- a characterization function can be used at least in part, e.g., to update one or more control parameters utilized in directing alteration of a tint state of the IGU. If already installed in an electrochromic window unit, the logic and features of the controller can be used (at least in part) to calibrate the one or more control parameters to match an intended installation. If already installed, the control parameters can be recalibrated to match one or more performance characteristics of the electrochromic device(s).
- a controller is not pre-associated with a window.
- a dock component e.g., having parts generic to any electrochromic window, may be associated with at least one (e.g., each) window at the factory (e.g., where the controller and/or window construct is produced).
- a second component of the controller may be combined with the dock component, e.g., to complete the electrochromic window controller assembly.
- the dock component may include a circuitry.
- the dock component may include a chip. The chip may be programmed at the factory.
- the programing of the chip may consider (e.g., take into account) one or more physical characteristics and/or parameters of the particular window to which the dock is attached. For example, on the surface which will face the building’s interior after installation, sometimes referred to as surface 4 or “S4.”
- the second component (referred to as a “carrier,” “casing,” or “housing”) can be mated with the dock. Once the second component is mated with the dock, it can be powered.
- the second component can be configured to read the chip.
- the second component may configure itself to electrically power the window, e.g., according to the particular one or more characteristics and/or parameters stored on the chip.
- the shipped window may require (e.g., only) its associated one or more characteristics and/or parameters stored on the chip.
- the chip may be integral with the window.
- the the more sophisticated circuitry (e.g., as compared to the chip) and/or components can be combined later with the controler-window assembly.
- the mor sophisticated circuitry and/or components may be (i) shipped separately from the window, dock, and/or second component, and/or (ii) installed by the window manufacturer after (a) the glazier has installed the windows and/or (b) followed by commissioning by the window manufacturer.
- the chip is included in a wire or wire connector (referred to herein as “pigtails”).
- the wire or wire connector may be attached to the window controller.
- outboard is understood herein to refer to a location closer to the outside environment
- inboard is understood herein to refer to a location closer to the interior of a building.
- the pane located closer to the outside environment is referred to as the outboard pane or outer pane
- the pane located closer to the inside of the building is referred to as the inboard pane or inner pane.
- the different surfaces of the IGU may be referred to as S1 , S2, S3, and S4 (assuming a two-pane IGU).
- S1 refers to the exterior-facing surface of the outboard lite (e.g., the surface that can be physically touched by someone standing outside).
- S2 refers to the interior-facing surface of the outboard lite.
- S3 refers to the exterior-facing surface of the inboard lite.
- S4 refers to the interior-facing surface of the inboard lite (e.g., the surface that can be physically touched by someone standing inside the building).
- the surfaces are labeled S1-S4, starting from the outermost surface of the IGU and counting inwards. In cases where an IGU includes three panes, this trend holds.
- the electrochromic device is disposed on S3.
- one or more of the surfaces has a structure for blocking transmission of electromagnetic radiation.
- the IGU may comprise a shielding stack of multiple conductive layers, e.g., on an internal surface such as S3 of Fig. 13. Additional aspects of shielding stack structures are presented in U.S. Patent Application Serial Number 15/709,339 filed September 19, 2017, which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
- window controllers Examples of window controllers and their features are presented in U.S. Patent Application Serial Number 13/449,248 filed April 17, 2012, and titled “CONTROLLER FOR OPTICALLY-SWITCHABLE WINDOWS”; U.S. Patent Application Serial Number 13/449,251 filed April 17, 2012, and titled “CONTROLLER FOR OPTICALLY-SWITCHABLE WINDOWS”; U.S.
- FIG. 12 shows an example of a schematic cross-section of an electrochromic device 1200 in accordance with some embodiments is shown in Fig. 12.
- the EC device coating is attached to a substrate 1202, a transparent conductive layer (TCL) 1204, an electrochromic layer (EC) 1206 (sometimes also referred to as a cathodically coloring layer or a cathodically tinting layer), an ion conducting layer or region (IC) 1208, a counter electrode layer (CE) 1210 (sometimes also referred to as an anodically coloring layer or anodically tinting layer), and a second TCL 1214.
- Elements 1204, 1206, 1208, 1210, and 1214 are collectively referred to as an electrochromic stack 1220.
- a voltage source 1216 operable to apply an electric potential across the electrochromic stack 1220 effects the transition of the electrochromic coating from, e.g., a clear state to a tinted state.
- the order of layers is reversed with respect to the substrate. That is, the layers are in the following order: substrate, TCL, counter electrode layer, ion conducting layer, electrochromic material layer, TCL.
- the ion conductor region e.g., 1208 may form from a portion of the EC layer (e.g., 1206) and/or from a portion of the CE layer (e.g., 1210).
- the electrochromic stack (e.g., 1220) may be deposited to include cathodically coloring electrochromic material (the EC layer) in direct physical contact with an anodically coloring counter electrode material (the CE layer).
- the ion conductor region (sometimes referred to as an interfacial region, or as an ion conducting substantially electronically insulating layer or region) may form where the EC layer and the CE layer meet, for example through heating and/or other processing steps. Examples of electrochromic devices (e.g., including those fabricated without depositing a distinct ion conductor material) can be found in U.S. Patent Application No.
- an EC device coating may include one or more additional layers such as one or more passive layers. Passive layers can be used to improve certain optical properties, to provide moisture, and/or to provide scratch resistance. These and/or other passive layers can serve to hermetically seal the EC stack 1220.
- the electrochromic device is configured to (e.g., substantially) reversibly cycle between a clear state and a tinted state. Reversible may be within an expected lifetime of the ECD.
- the expected lifetime can be at least about 5, 10, 15, 25, 50, 75, or 100 years.
- the expected lifetime can be any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 5 years to about 100 years, from about 5 years to about 50 years, or from about 50 years to about 100 years).
- a potential can be applied to the electrochromic stack (e.g., 1220) such that available ions in the stack that can cause the electrochromic material (e.g., 1206) to be in the tinted state reside primarily in the counter electrode (e.g., 1210) when the window is in a first tint state (e.g., clear).
- the ions can be transported across the ion conducting layer (e.g., 1208) to the electrochromic material and cause the material to enter the second tint state (e.g., tinted state).
- the reference to a transition between a clear state and tinted state is non-limiting and suggests only one example, among many, of an electrochromic transition that may be implemented. Unless otherwise specified herein, whenever reference is made to a clear-tinted transition, the corresponding device or process encompasses other optical state transitions such as non-reflective-reflective, and/or transparent-opaque.
- the terms “clear” and “bleached” refer to an optically neutral state, e.g., untinted, transparent and/or translucent.
- the “color” or “tint” of an electrochromic transition is not limited to any wavelength or range of wavelengths. The choice of appropriate electrochromic material and counter electrode materials may govern the relevant optical transition (e.g., from tinted to untinted state).
- At least a portion (e.g., all of) the materials making up electrochromic stack are inorganic, solid (e.g., in the solid state), or both inorganic and solid. Because various organic materials tend to degrade over time, particularly when exposed to heat and UV light as tinted building windows are, inorganic materials offer an advantage of a reliable electrochromic stack that can function for extended periods of time. In some embodiments, materials in the solid state can offer the advantage of being minimally contaminated and minimizing leakage issues, as materials in the liquid state sometimes do. One or more of the layers in the stack may contain some amount of organic material (e.g., that is measurable).
- the ECD or any portion thereof may contain little or no measurable organic matter.
- the ECD or any portion thereof may contain one or more liquids that may be present in little amounts. Little may be of at most about 100ppm, 10ppm, or 1ppm of the ECD.
- Solid state material may be deposited (or otherwise formed) using one or more processes employing liquid components, such as certain processes employing sol-gels, physical vapor deposition, and/or chemical vapor deposition.
- FIGs. 13 show an example of a cross-sectional view of a tintable window embodied in an insulated glass unit (“IGU”) 1300, in accordance with some implementations.
- IGU insulated glass unit
- the terms “IGU,” “tintable window,” and “optically switchable window” can be used interchangeably herein. It can be desirable to have IGUs serve as the fundamental constructs for holding electrochromic panes (also referred to herein as “lites”) when provided for installation in a building.
- An IGU lite may be a single substrate or a multi-substrate construct. The lite may comprise a laminate, e.g., of two substrates.
- IGUs can provide a number of advantages over single pane configurations.
- multi-pane configurations can provide enhanced thermal insulation, noise insulation, environmental protection and/or durability, when compared with single-pane configurations.
- a multi-pane configuration can provide increased protection for an ECD.
- the electrochromic films e.g., as well as associated layers and conductive interconnects
- the inert gas fill may provide at least some (heat) insulating function for an IGU.
- Electrochromic IGUs may have heat blocking capability, e.g., by virtue of a tintable coating that absorbs (and/or reflects) heat and light.
- an “IGU” includes two (or more) substantially transparent substrates.
- the IGU may include two panes of glass. At least one substrate of the IGU can include an electrochromic device disposed thereon. The one or more panes of the IGU may have a separator disposed between them.
- An IGU can be a hermetically sealed construct, e.g., having an interior region that is isolated from the ambient environment.
- a “window assembly” may include an IGU.
- a “window assembly” may include a (e.g., standalone) laminate.
- a “window assembly” may include one or more electrical leads, e.g., for connecting the IGUs and/or laminates. The electrical leads may operatively couple (e.g.
- a window assembly may include a local controller (e.g., window controller), and/or control components of a local controller (e.g., a dock).
- a local controller e.g., window controller
- control components of a local controller e.g., a dock
- Fig. 13 shows an example implementation of an IGU 1300 that includes a first pane 1304 having a first surface S1 and a second surface S2.
- the first surface S1 of the first pane 1304 faces an exterior environment, such as an outdoors or outside environment.
- the IGU 1300 also includes a second pane 1306 having a first surface S3 and a second surface S4.
- the second surface (e.g., S4) of the second pane e.g., 1306) faces an interior environment, such as an inside environment of a home, building, vehicle, or compartment thereof (e.g., an enclosure therein such as a room).
- the first and the second panes are transparent or translucent, e.g., at least to light in the visible spectrum.
- each of the panes can be formed of a glass material.
- the glass material may include architectural glass, and/or shatter-resistant glass.
- the glass may comprise a silicon oxide (SO x ).
- the glass may comprise a soda-lime glass or float glass.
- the glass may comprise at least about 75% silica (SiO 2 ).
- the glass may comprise oxides such as Na 2 O, or CaO.
- the glass may comprise alkali or alkali-earth oxides.
- the glass may comprise one or more additives.
- the first and/or the second panes can include any material having suitable optical, electrical, thermal, and/or mechanical properties.
- Other materials (e.g., substrates) that can be included in the first and/or the second panes are plastic, semi-plastic and/or thermoplastic materials, for example, poly(methyl methacrylate), polystyrene, polycarbonate, allyl diglycol carbonate, SAN (styrene acrylonitrile copolymer), poly(4-methyl-1-pentene), polyester, and/or polyamide.
- the first and/or second pane may include mirror material (e.g., silver).
- the first and/or the second panes can be strengthened. The strengthening may include tempering, heating, and/or chemically strengthening.
- Fig. 14 shows a schematic example of a computer system 1400 that is programmed or otherwise configured to one or more operations of any of the methods provided herein.
- the computer system can control (e.g., direct, monitor, and/or regulate) various features of the methods, apparatuses and systems of the present disclosure, such as, for example, control heating, cooling, lightening, and/or venting of an enclosure, or any combination thereof.
- the computer system can be part of, or be in communication with, any sensor or sensor ensemble disclosed herein.
- the computer may be coupled to one or more mechanisms disclosed herein, and/or any parts thereof.
- the computer may be coupled to one or more sensors, valves, switches, lights, windows (e.g., IGUs), motors, pumps, optical components, or any combination thereof.
- the computer system can include a processing unit (e.g., 1406) (also “processor,” “computer” and “computer processor” used herein).
- the computer system may include memory or memory location (e.g., 1402) (e.g., random-access memory, read-only memory, flash memory), electronic storage unit (e.g., 1404) (e.g., hard disk), communication interface (e.g., 1403) (e.g., network adapter) for communicating with one or more other systems, and peripheral devices (e.g., 1405), such as cache, other memory, data storage and/or electronic display adapters.
- memory or memory location e.g., 1402
- electronic storage unit e.g., 1404
- communication interface e.g., 1403
- peripheral devices e.g., 1405
- the memory 1402, storage unit 1404, interface 1403, and peripheral devices 1405 are in communication with the processing unit 1406 through a communication bus (solid lines), such as a motherboard.
- the storage unit can be a data storage unit (or data repository) for storing data.
- the computer system can be operatively coupled to a computer network (“network”) (e.g., 1401) with the aid of the communication interface.
- the network can be the Internet, an internet and/or extranet, or an intranet and/or extranet that is in communication with the Internet.
- the network is a telecommunication and/or data network.
- the network can include one or more computer servers, which can enable distributed computing, such as cloud computing.
- the network in some cases with the aid of the computer system, can implement a peer-to-peer network, which may enable devices coupled to the computer system to behave as a client or a server.
- the processing unit can execute a sequence of machine-readable instructions, which can be embodied in a program or software.
- the instructions may be stored in a memory location, such as the memory 1402.
- the instructions can be directed to the processing unit, which can subsequently program or otherwise configure the processing unit to implement methods of the present disclosure. Examples of operations performed by the processing unit can include fetch, decode, execute, and write back.
- the processing unit may interpret and/or execute instructions.
- the processor may include a microprocessor, a data processor, a central processing unit (CPU), a graphical processing unit (GPU), a system-on- chip (SOC), a co-processor, a network processor, an application specific integrated circuit (ASIC), an application specific instruction-set processor (ASIPs), a controller, a programmable logic device (PLD), a chipset, a field programmable gate array (FPGA), or any combination thereof.
- the processing unit can be part of a circuit, such as an integrated circuit.
- One or more other electronic components of the system 1400 can be included in the circuit.
- the storage unit can store files, such as drivers, libraries and saved programs.
- the storage unit can store user data (e.g., user preferences and user programs).
- the computer system can include one or more additional data storage units that are external to the computer system, such as located on a remote server that is in communication with the computer system through an intranet or the Internet.
- the computer system can communicate with one or more remote computer systems through a network.
- the computer system can communicate with a remote computer system of a user (e.g., operator).
- remote computer systems include personal computers (e.g., portable PC), slate or tablet PC's (e.g., Apple® iPad, Samsung® Galaxy Tab), telephones, Smart phones (e.g., Apple® iPhone, Android-enabled device, Blackberry®), or personal digital assistants.
- a user e.g., client
- Methods as described herein can be implemented by way of machine (e.g., computer processor) executable code stored on an electronic storage location of the computer system, such as, for example, on the memory 1402 or electronic storage unit 1404.
- the machine executable or machine-readable code can be provided in the form of software.
- the processor 1406 can execute the code.
- the code can be retrieved from the storage unit and stored on the memory for ready access by the processor.
- the electronic storage unit can be precluded, and machine- executable instructions are stored on memory.
- the code can be pre-compiled and configured for use with a machine have a processer adapted to execute the code or can be compiled during runtime.
- the code can be supplied in a programming language that can be selected to enable the code to execute in a pre-compiled or as-compiled fashion.
- the processor comprises a code.
- the code can be program instructions.
- the program instructions may cause the at least one processor (e.g., computer) to direct a feed forward and/or feedback control loop.
- the program instructions cause the at least one processor to direct a closed loop and/or open loop control scheme.
- the control may be based at least in part on one or more sensor readings (e.g., sensor data).
- One controller may direct a plurality of operations. At least two operations may be directed by different controllers. In some embodiments, a different controller may direct at least two of operations (a), (b) and (c). In some embodiments, different controllers may direct at least two of operations (a), (b) and (c).
- a non-transitory computer- readable medium cause each a different computer to direct at least two of operations (a), (b) and (c). In some embodiments, different non-transitory computer-readable mediums cause each a different computer to direct at least two of operations (a), (b) and (c).
- the controller and/or computer readable media may direct any of the apparatuses or components thereof disclosed herein. The controller and/or computer readable media may direct any operations of the methods disclosed herein.
- the at least one sensor is operatively coupled to a control system (e.g., computer control system).
- the sensor may comprise light sensor, acoustic sensor, vibration sensor, chemical sensor, electrical sensor, magnetic sensor, fluidity sensor, movement sensor, speed sensor, position sensor, pressure sensor, force sensor, density sensor, distance sensor, or proximity sensor.
- the sensor may include temperature sensor, weight sensor, material (e.g., powder) level sensor, metrology sensor, gas sensor, or humidity sensor.
- the metrology sensor may comprise measurement sensor (e.g., height, length, width, angle, and/or volume).
- the metrology sensor may comprise a magnetic, acceleration, orientation, or optical sensor.
- the sensor may transmit and/or receive sound (e.g., echo), magnetic, electronic, or electromagnetic signal.
- the electromagnetic signal may comprise a visible, infrared, ultraviolet, ultrasound, radio wave, or microwave signal.
- the gas sensor may sense any of the gas delineated herein.
- the distance sensor can be a type of metrology sensor.
- the distance sensor may comprise an optical sensor, or capacitance sensor.
- the temperature sensor can comprise Bolometer, Bimetallic strip, calorimeter, Exhaust gas temperature gauge, Flame detection, Gardon gauge, Golay cell, Heat flux sensor, Infrared thermometer, Microbolometer, Microwave radiometer, Net radiometer, Quartz thermometer, Resistance temperature detector, Resistance thermometer, Silicon band gap temperature sensor, Special sensor microwave/imager, Temperature gauge, Thermistor, Thermocouple, Thermometer (e.g., resistance thermometer), or Pyrometer.
- the temperature sensor may comprise an optical sensor.
- the temperature sensor may comprise image processing.
- the temperature sensor may comprise a camera (e.g., IR camera, visible light camera, CCD camera).
- the sensor may comprise a sensor array (e.g., an IR sensor array).
- the camera and/or sensor array may comprise at least 2000, 3000, or 4000 pixels at its fundamental length scale.
- the sensor may be configured to detect radio frequency.
- the device may comprise a geo-location device (e.g., a device including Bluetooth, GPS, and/or UWV gelo-location technology).
- the sensor may comprise an acoustic sensor.
- the pressure sensor may comprise Barograph, Barometer, Boost gauge, Bourdon gauge, Hot filament ionization gauge, Ionization gauge, McLeod gauge, Oscillating U-tube, Permanent Downhole Gauge, Piezometer, Pirani gauge, Pressure sensor, Pressure gauge, Tactile sensor, or Time pressure gauge.
- the position sensor may comprise Auxanometer, Capacitive displacement sensor, Capacitive sensing, Free fall sensor, Gravimeter, Gyroscopic sensor, Impact sensor, Inclinometer, Integrated circuit piezoelectric sensor, Laser rangefinder, Laser surface velocimeter, LIDAR, Linear encoder, Linear variable differential transformer (LVDT), Liquid capacitive inclinometers, Odometer, Photoelectric sensor, Piezoelectric accelerometer, Rate sensor, Rotary encoder, Rotary variable differential transformer, Selsyn, Shock detector, Shock data logger, Tilt sensor, Tachometer, Ultrasonic thickness gauge, Variable reluctance sensor, or Velocity receiver.
- Auxanometer Capacitive displacement sensor, Capacitive sensing, Free fall sensor, Gravimeter, Gyroscopic sensor, Impact sensor, Inclinometer, Integrated circuit piezoelectric sensor, Laser rangefinder, Laser surface velocimeter, LIDAR, Linear encoder, Linear variable differential transformer (LVDT), Liquid capacitive inclinometers, Odometer,
- the optical sensor may comprise a Charge-coupled device, Colorimeter, Contact image sensor, Electro-optical sensor, Infra-red sensor, Kinetic inductance detector, light emitting diode (e.g., light sensor), Light-addressable potentiometric sensor, Nichols radiometer, Fiber optic sensor, Optical position sensor, Photo detector, Photodiode, Photomultiplier tubes, Phototransistor, Photoelectric sensor, Photoionization detector, Photomultiplier, Photo resistor, Photo switch, Phototube, Scintillometer, Shack- Hartmann, Single-photon avalanche diode, Superconducting nanowire single-photon detector, Transition edge sensor, Visible light photon counter, or Wave front sensor.
- a Charge-coupled device e.g., Colorimeter, Contact image sensor, Electro-optical sensor, Infra-red sensor, Kinetic inductance detector, light emitting diode (e.g., light sensor), Light-addressable potentiometric sensor
- the one or more sensors may be connected to a control system (e.g., to a processor, to a computer).
- the target device and/or the (local) network is configured for radio communication.
- the target device may comprise a transceiver.
- a transceiver and/or the local network may be configured transmit and receive one or more signals using a personal area network (PAN) standard, for example such as IEEE 802.15.4.
- PAN personal area network
- signals may comprise Bluetooth, Wi-Fi, or EnOcean signals (e.g., wide bandwidth).
- the one or more signals may comprise ultra-wide bandwidth (UWB) signals (e.g., having a frequency in the range from about 2.4 to about 10.6 Giga Hertz (GHz), or from about 7.5 GHz to about 10.6GHz).
- An Ultra-wideband signal can be one having a fractional bandwidth greater than about 20%.
- An ultra-wideband signal can have a bandwidth greater than about 500 Mega Hertz (MHz).
- the one or more signals may use a very low energy level for short-range. Signals (e.g., having radio frequency) may employ a spectrum capable of penetrating solid structures (e.g., wall, door, and/or window). Low power may be of at most 25 milli Watts (mW), 50 mW, 75 mW, or 100 mW.
- Low power may be any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from 25mW to 100mW, from 25mW to 50mW, or from 75mW to 100mW).
- the local network e.g., comprising one or more stationary sensors and/or stationary transceivers
- the local network is configured to (I) located a transitory transceiver in real time, (II) locate the transitory transceiver to an accuracy of about 20, 10, or 5 centimeters or to a higher accuracy, (III) transmit and sense ultrawide radio waves, and/or (IV) operatively couple to a control system configured to control a facility in which the local network of one or more stationary sensors and/or stationary transceivers are disposed.
- the local network incorporates and/or facilitates geo-location technology (e.g., global positioning system (GPS), Bluetooth (BLE), ultrawide band (UWB) and/or dead-reckoning), e.g., using a micro-location chip.
- geo-location technology may facilitate determination of a position of signal source (e.g., location of a transitory tag comprising a transceiver facilitating the geo-location technology) to an accuracy of at least 100 centimeters (cm), 75cm, 50cm, 25cm, 20cm, 10cm, or 5cm.
- the electromagnetic radiation of the signal comprises ultra-wideband (UWB) radio waves, ultra- high frequency (UHF) radio waves, or radio waves utilized in global positioning system (GPS).
- the electromagnetic radiation comprises electromagnetic waves of a frequency of at least about 300MHz, 500MHz, or 1200MHz.
- the signal comprises location and/or time data.
- the tag utilizes Bluetooth, UWB, UHF, and/or global positioning system (GPS) technology.
- the signal has a spatial capacity of at least about 1013 bits per second per meter squared (bit/s/m 2 ).
- pulse-based ultra-wideband (UWB) technology is a wireless technology for transmitting large amounts of data at low power (e.g., less than about 1 millivolt (mW), 0.75mW, 0.5mW, or 0.25mW) over short distances (e.g., of at most about 300 feet (‘), 250’, 230’, 200’, or 150’).
- a UWB signal can occupy at least about 750MHz, 500 MHz, or 250MHz of bandwidth spectrum, and/or at least about 30%, 20%, or 10% of its center frequency.
- the UWB signal can be transmitted by one or more pulses.
- a component broadcasts digital signal pulses may be timed (e.g., precisely) on a carrier signal across a number of frequency channels at the same time.
- Information may be transmitted, e.g., by modulating the timing and/or positioning of the signal (e.g., the pulses).
- Signal information may be transmitted by encoding the polarity of the signal (e.g., pulse), its amplitude and/or by using orthogonal signals (e.g., pulses).
- the UWB signal may be a low power information transfer protocol.
- the UWB technology may be utilized for (e.g., indoor) location applications.
- the broad range of the UWB spectrum comprises low frequencies having long wavelengths, which allows UWB signals to penetrate a variety of materials, including various building fixtures (e.g., walls).
- the wide range of frequencies e.g., including the low penetrating frequencies, may decrease the chance of multipath propagation errors (without wishing to be bound to theory, as some wavelengths may have a line-of-sight trajectory).
- UWB communication signals may be short (e.g., of at most about 70cm, 60 cm, or 50cm for a pulse that is about 600MHz, 500 MHz, or 400MHz wide; or of at most about 20cm, 23 cm, 25cm, or 30cm for a pulse that is has a bandwidth of about 1 GHz, 1 2GHz, 1 .3 GHz, or 1 5GHz).
- the short communication signals e.g., pulses
- the short communication signals may reduce the chance that reflecting signals (e.g., pulses) will overlap with the original signal (e.g., pulse).
- a building network infrastructure has a vertical data plane (between building floors) and a horizontal data plane (within a single floor or multiple contiguous floors).
- the horizontal and vertical data planes may have at least one data carrying capability that is (e.g., substantially) similar.
- the horizontal and vertical data plane may have at least one type of network components that is (e.g., substantially) similar. In other cases, these two data planes have different data carrying capabilities.
- the horizontal and vertical data planes have (e.g., substantially) the same (or similar) data carrying capabilities and/or type of network components.
- the vertical and horizontal data planes have at least one (e.g., all) data carrying capability and/or network component that is different from each other.
- the vertical data plane may contain network components for fast communication (e.g., data transmission) rates and/or bandwidths.
- the faster communication rates may be at least about 1 Gigabits per second (Gbit/s), 10 Gbit/s, 50 Gbit/s, 100 Gbit/s, 250 Gbit/s, 500 Gbit/s, 750 Gbit/s, 1 terabits per second (Tbit/s), or 1 .125 Tbit/s.
- the faster communication rates can be any communication rate between the aforementioned rates (e.g., from about 1 Gbit/s to about 1.125 Tbit/s, from about 1 Gbit/s to about 500 Gbit/s, or from about 250 Gbit/s to about 1 .125 Tbit/s).
- Figs. 15-18 presents network topologies that may be substituted for topologies presented for some other embodiments disclosed herein, e.g., network topologies of Figs. 15-18, may be substituted for linear bus topologies in some cases.
- the network topologies described with respect to Figs. 15-18 may employ control components such control panels that may have functions and/or design elements that are similar to and/or overlap with components described in other embodiments presented herein.
- the data carried on and/or the data protocols employed in the topologies of Figs. 15-18 may be substituted by or supplemented with data and/or data protocols described in other embodiments presented herein.
- the vertical and/or horizontal data may be configured such that the electrically conductive data carrying lines may carry electrical power to end devices, in certain embodiments.
- FIG. 15 shows three possible physical network topologies A, B and C for providing data communications between a control panel 1 and building devices 2 arranged around the perimeter of a building floor 1503. Dashed lines indicated (e.g., high-speed) data communication paths provided by fiber optic cabling.
- Network topology A has a star configuration in which each building device 2 is connected directly to the control panel 1 by a dedicated (e.g., fiber optic cable) link.
- Network topology A can be easy to design and implement (e.g., requires minimal labor hours and/or cost). Network A can facilitates addition of new building devices to the network. However, the central single control panel may present a single point of failure in the network. Should a fault develop at the control panel 1 , data communications to all building devices 2 on the floor could be affected. In addition, the amount of wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cabling) required for the network scales linearly with the number of building devices 2.
- wiring e.g., fiber optic or other cabling
- Network topology B has a distributed star (or tree) configuration in which the building devices 2 are connected to the central control panel 1 by way of intermediate control panels 1', each intermediate control panel 1' being associated with multiple building devices 2.
- Network topology B can reduce the amount of wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cabling), compared to topology A, which wiring is required to provide data communications for each building device 2 in the network.
- the amount of wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cabling) required for the network B scales linearly as more devices are added to the network, the length of wiring required for each additional device in topology B is smaller than in topology A.
- network topology B incorporating more control panels than network topology A, such that the level of physical redundancy is increased to an extent, the central control panel 1 represents a single point of failure in the network.
- Network topology C has a linear configuration in which device 2 is connected to the central control panel 1 via a linear (e.g., fiber optic or other cable) bus.
- Network topology C reduces the amount of wiring required to connect each device 2 to the control panel 1 relative to network topology A.
- a ring topology is employed for the data communications and/or electrical power distribution lines of a building floor.
- the wiring, control panels, radios, antennas, and other network components associated with the ring are located in and/or on the building’s outer structures (or skin).
- at least some (e.g., all) network components of other network topologies described herein may be disposed in the enclosure (e.g., building) skin.
- a building’s skin may include various structures that serve as the building’s outer construction.
- the building skin may comprise fixtures (e.g., walls). Examples include a building’s exterior walls, exterior windows, optionally including optically switchable windows, façade, window framing structure, and the like.
- the building’s skin includes mullions, transoms, and/or other structures that may provide interior passages for network wiring and/or may provide support surfaces on which to mount control panels or other network devices.
- the network and/or power distribution components disposed on the building skin may provide data communications and/or electrical power distribution functions such as telecommunications, a computing platform, wired or wireless power for the building, and/or other attributes described herein.
- At least a portion (e.g., all) communication and/or electrical power distribution components are installed during (e.g., early in) the building construction process (e.g., before constructing interior rooms, before installing exterior windows, or before installing IT infrastructure, etc.). In certain embodiments, at least a portion (e.g., all) communication and/or electrical power distribution components are installed after the building construction process has ended. In certain embodiments, at least a portion (e.g., all) communication and/or electrical power distribution components are installed during occupation of the building. In some cases, at least a portion of the communication and/or electrical power distribution components are available to construction personnel to facilitate construction and installation operations.
- the communication and/or electrical power distribution system (e.g., network system) initially installed in the building skin is not configured to control some or all building devices such as sensors, emitters, and/or tintable (e.g., optically switchable) windows
- the network system e.g., controllers operatively coupled thereto
- one vendor provides some or all of the communications and electrical power distribution infrastructure on the building skin, and a second vendor provides sensing units and/or optically switchable windows that attach to the infrastructure and are ultimately controlled by it.
- Fig. 16A shows a schematic plan view of a physical network topology for a floor 1600 of a building in accordance with some embodiments of the present disclosure.
- the floor network includes distributed control panels 1601 , 1602, 1603, 1604, 1605 and 1606 connected to one another in series by segments of first wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cable) 1607, 1608, 1609, 1610, 1611 and 1612 to form a primary first wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cable) ring.
- Each distributed control panel 1601 , 1602, 1603, 1604, 1605 and 1606 forms a node in the primary ring.
- the primary ring may extend around the floor adjacent the perimeter of the floor.
- Each distributed control panel 1601 , 1602, 1603, 1604, 1605 and 1606 is also connected to a corresponding second wiring (e.g., coaxial or other cable) network branch 1601', 1602', 1603', 1604', 1605' and 1606'.
- Each second (e.g., coaxial or other cable) network branch extends along a respective portion of the perimeter of the building floor.
- a given control panel may include two or more second wiring (e.g., coaxial or other cable) branches, although each of them is not numbered in the figures.
- the first wiring and the second wiring may be of a different wiring type.
- the first wiring and the second wiring may be of (e.g., substantially) the same wiring type.
- FIG. 16B An example second wiring (e.g., coaxial or other cable) network branch 1601' is shown in more detail in Fig. 16B.
- the network branch 1601' includes branch devices 1613, 1614, 1615, 1616 and 1617 coupled to linear second wiring (e.g., coaxial or other cable) branch lines 1618 and 1619 by corresponding second wiring (e.g., coaxial or other cable) drop lines 1613', 1614', 1615', 1616' and 1617'.
- the drop lines 1613', 1614', 1615', 1616' and 1617' may be connected to the linear second wiring branch lines 1618 and 1619 by way of taps 1623, 1624, 1625, 1626 and 1627.
- Device controllers e.g., local controllers
- the branch targets (e.g., devices) 1613, 1614, 1615, 1616 and 1617 may be any type of building devices which require an electrical power and/or data supply.
- the branch devices may include one or more electrochromic devices (such as electrochromic windows or insulated glass units (IGUs)), external sensing devices (such as light or weather sensors), internal sensing devices (such as internal air quality monitoring devices or asset tracking devices), communications devices (such as antennas, receivers, transceivers or radios), digital architectural elements, or building security devices (such as burglar alarms), lighting, or HVAC components.
- electrochromic devices such as electrochromic windows or insulated glass units (IGUs)
- external sensing devices such as light or weather sensors
- internal sensing devices such as internal air quality monitoring devices or asset tracking devices
- communications devices such as antennas, receivers, transceivers or radios
- digital architectural elements such as burglar alarms
- building security devices such as burglar alarms
- the distributed control panel 1601 includes a headend unit 1628 and is connected to a (e.g., dedicated) electrical power supply 1629, e.g., an AC power supply.
- the dedicated AC power supply is provided by a power supply line, such as a coaxial or other cable line.
- the dedicated power line can extend around the perimeter of the building, e.g., in parallel to other (e.g., fiber optic) cabling of the primary ring.
- the distributed control panel is connected to a DC power supply, for example by way of a DC power supply line.
- the DC power supply line may extend around the perimeter of the building, e.g., in parallel to the (e.g., fiber optic) cabling of the primary ring.
- the headend unit 1628 in the distributed control panel 1601 can function as a gateway for data communication between the first wiring (e.g., fiber optic) primary ring and the second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branch 1601'.
- first wiring e.g., fiber optic
- second wiring e.g., coaxial cable
- Each of the second wiring network branches 1602', 1603', 1604', 1605' and 1606' can be similar in format to branch 1601 ', although the number and types of branch devices and device controllers present in each branch may differ, e.g., dependent on the requirements of the building.
- the fiber optic primary ring connects the distributed control panels 1601 , 1602, 1603, 1604, 1605 and 1606 around the ring to a building (e.g., Ethernet) network configured for communication of data, such as control data for controlling the various branch devices.
- the first wiring (e.g., fiber optic) primary ring can support high-speed data transmission, at speeds, e.g., greater than about 1 Gbit/s per channel (e.g., at least about 10 Gbit/s per channel), optionally with low transmission loss and diminished (e.g., little or no) interference.
- the fiber optic primary ring 1612 does not provide electrical power transmission to the distributed control panels.
- the second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branches 1601', 1602', 1603', 1604', 1605' and 1606' connect the distributed control panels 1601 , 1602, 1603, 1604, 1605 and 1606 around the ring to the branch devices in each second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branch.
- the second wiring may supply both electrical power and data.
- Electrical power can be supplied to the distributed control panels by one or more dedicated power supplies. In embodiments in which AC power is supplied to the distributed control panels, power can be rectified to DC, and may be transformed to a low voltage, e.g., of about 24 V DC, (for example, by an AC to DC converter) within the distributed control panels.
- the lower voltage power can be transmitted to the branch devices, e.g., via the second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) branch lines.
- power can be transformed to a low voltage (for example, by a DC to DC converter) within the distributed control panels.
- the lower voltage power can be transmitted to the branch devices via the second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) branch lines.
- Data from the firs wiring (e.g., fiber optic) primary ring can be received by the headend unit in the distributed control panels and transmitted to the branch devices via the second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) branch lines, e.g., using a protocol such as MoCA, G.hn, and/or any of various cellular communications protocols.
- electrical power is transmitted on the second wiring (e.g., coaxial) line using, e.g., a DC power-line communication (PLC) protocol and/or a power over ethernet protocol.
- PLC DC power-line communication
- the PLC methods can enable both electrical power and data to be transmitted to the branch devices along a single branch line.
- Each distributed control panel node in the primary ring shown in Fig. 16A can be accessible by two different first wiring (e.g., fiber optic) paths, e.g., due to the network ring topology.
- first wiring e.g., fiber optic
- STP Spanning Tree Protocol
- the redundancy can be advantageous when one or more network branches include branch device(s) used for applications which require high reliability (e.g., diminished number of failure incidents), such as burglar alarms or communications devices.
- the distributed control panels also contain devices for connecting to a Wireless Local Area Network (e.g. via Wi-Fi), providing an additional layer of fault-tolerance redundancy.
- the ring topology of the network shown in Fig. 16A can be simple to install (e.g., requires less labor, labor force that is less trained, and/or cheaper to install). Moreover, the use of linear second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branches around the primary ring can provide a significant cost reduction, e.g., by reducing the length of first wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cabling) required to provide all devices in the network with (e.g., high-speed) data communications.
- the topology illustrated in Fig. 16A may strike a balance between fault-tolerance across the floor, supply of (e.g., high-speed) data communications, ease of installation, and low cost of installation.
- a building network infrastructure has a vertical data plane (between building floors) and one or more horizontal data planes (within a floor or in multiple (e.g., contiguous) floors).
- the horizontal and vertical data planes have (e.g., substantially) the same or similar data carrying capabilities and/or data communication carrying components. In other cases, these two data planes have at least one different data carrying capability.
- the vertical data plane contains data carrying communication components that support at least about 10 Gigabit/second or faster Ethernet transmissions (e.g., using UTP wires and/or fiber optic cables), and the horizontal data plane contains data carrying components that also support at least about 10 Gigabit/second or faster gigabit Ethernet transmissions, e.g., via optical fiber.
- the horizontal data plane supports data transmission via a communication protocol (e.g., G.hn protocol and/or a MoCA protocol such as the MoCA 2.5 standard or the MoCA 3.0 standard).
- connections between at least two floors on the vertical data plane employ control panels with (e.g., high speed) Ethernet switches.
- control panels may communicate with node(s) on a given floor via a (e.g., high-speed) a switch (e.g., optical fiber switch) and/or a communication protocol (e.g., MoCA) interface and associated (e.g., coaxial) cables disposed on the horizontal data plane.
- a switch e.g., optical fiber switch
- a communication protocol e.g., MoCA
- Fig. 17A shows an example of a physical network topology for a floor 1700 of a building includes distributed control panels 1701 , 1702, 1703, 1704, 1705 and 1706 connected to one another in series by segments of firs wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cable) 1707, 1708, 1709, 1710, 1711 and 1712 to form a primary first wiring ring 1713.
- the network also includes distributed control panels 1714, 1715 and 1716 connected to one another in series by segments of first wiring 1717, 1718 and 1719 to form a secondary first wiring ring 1720 within the primary ring 1713.
- the first wiring designates a first wiring type.
- the secondary ring 1720 is connected to the primary ring 1713 by a segment of first wiring 1721 .
- Each distributed control panel 1701 , 1702, 1703, 1704, 1705 and 1706 forms a node in the primary ring 1713, while each distributed control panel 1714, 1715 and 1716 forms a node in the secondary ring 1720.
- 1706, 1714, 1715 and 1716 is also connected to a corresponding second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branch 1701', 1702', 1703', 1704', 1705', 1706', 1714', 1715' and 1716'.
- the second wiring designates a second wiring type.
- the primary ring 1713 extends around the floor adjacent the perimeter of the floor, while each of the primary ring second wiring network branches 1701', 1702', 1703', 1704', 1705' and 1706' extend along a respective portion of the perimeter of the building floor.
- the secondary ring 1720 extends around the center of the floor, within the primary ring 1713, as do each of the secondary ring second wiring network branches 1714', 1715' and 1716'.
- the control panels and second wiring lines of the secondary ring are located in the interior regions of a building’s floor, e.g., interior to the floor’s physical perimeter where the primary ring 1713 is located.
- the secondary ring may be located on and/or within the interior walls, fixtures, or other structures of a floor. Such structures are typically constructed after the building’s perimeter or skin is constructed. Thus, in some cases, a floor’s primary ring is constructed before its secondary ring.
- the first and second wiring may be of the same wiring type.
- the first and second wiring may be of a different wiring type.
- each second wiring network branch 1701', 1702', 1703', 1704', 1705', 1706', 1714', 1715' and 1716' includes one or more branch devices coupled to linear second wiring branch lines by corresponding second wiring drop lines (and device controllers as required).
- Each distributed control panel 1701 , 1702, 1703, 1704, 1705, 1706, 1714, 1715 and 1716 includes a corresponding headend unit and has a corresponding AC power supply.
- the headend unit in each distributed control panel functions as a gateway for data communication between the first wiring primary ring 1713 or the first wiring (e.g., fiber optic) secondary ring 1720 and the respective second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branch.
- the first wiring primary ring 1713 and the first wiring secondary ring 1720 connect the distributed control panels on the rings to the building Ethernet network for (e.g., high-speed) data communication purposes.
- the second wiring network branches placed around the rings connect the various distributed control panels to the branch devices for the supply of both electrical power and data. Electrical power is supplied to the distributed control panels by the dedicated AC power supplies, which is rectified to DC within the distributed control panels and transmitted to the branch devices via the second wiring branch lines.
- Data from the first wiring primary and secondary rings 1713 and 1720 is received by the headend units in the distributed control panels and transmitted to the branch devices via the second wring branch lines using, e.g., a communication protocol (e.g., a G.hn, MoCA, and/or a cellular protocol).
- a communication protocol e.g., a G.hn, MoCA, and/or a cellular protocol.
- DC power may be transmitted using a power-line communication (PLC) and/or electrical power over ethernet method.
- PLC power-line communication
- each distributed control panel node in the primary ring 1713 is accessible by two different first wiring (e.g., fiber optic) paths due to the network ring topology.
- each distributed control panel node in the secondary ring 1720 is also accessible by at least two different first wiring paths.
- network protocols such as Spanning Tree Protocol (STP)
- STP Spanning Tree Protocol
- a given node in the primary ring 1713 develops a fault which hinders (e.g., prevents) communication of signals through that node
- communication with neighboring nodes on the primary ring is not prevented as each node can be reached via an alternative path.
- distributed control panels 1715 or 1716 in the secondary ring 1720 develop a fault which hinders (e.g., prevents) communication of signals through that node
- communication with neighboring nodes on the secondary ring is not hindered (e.g., prevented) as they can be reached via an alternative path.
- a secondary ring in the floor network can enable data and electrical power to be supplied to one or more branch devices located within the interior of the building.
- a network topology can be suited to floor designs which incorporate internal rooms, other closed spaces, or internal open spaces, such as atria. Interior open spaces may be surrounded by branch targets (e.g., devices) such as electrochromic windows, antennas, or sensor units.
- branch targets e.g., devices
- the secondary ring may be arranged around an interior perimeter of the building, e.g., around a perimeter of an internal open space in the building.
- a secondary ring topology may be suited to floor designs which do not incorporate internal open spaces.
- the secondary ring may supply electrical power and data to branch devices located within the interior of the building, for example to electrochromic windows incorporated into room dividers, to internal sensors, or to burglar alarms.
- the primary ring 1713 and secondary ring 1720 of the floor network may be installed at the same time, or at different times. The times may be during and/or after construction of the building.
- the secondary ring 1720 may be installed after the primary ring 1713 is installed.
- the primary ring 1713 may be installed when the building is constructed and the secondary ring 1720 may be added to the floor network later, when the interior arrangement of the floor is determined or reconfigured.
- FIG. 17B shows an example of a physical network topology for a floor 1700 of a building includes distributed control panels 1701 , 1702, 1703, 1704, 1705 and 1706 connected to one another in series by segments of the first wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cable) 1707, 1708, 1709, 1710, 1711 and 1712 to form a primary first wiring ring 1713.
- the network also includes distributed control panels 1714, 1715 and 1716 connected to one another in series by segments of first wiring 1717, 1718 and 1719 to form a secondary first wiring ring 1720 within the primary ring 1713.
- the secondary ring 1720 is connected to the primary ring 1713 at two different locations by segments of first wiring 1721 and 1722.
- Each distributed control panel 1701 , 1702, 1703, 1704, 1705 and 1706 forms a node in the primary ring 1713, while each distributed control panel 1714, 1715 and 1716 forms a node in the secondary ring 1720.
- 1706, 1714, 1715 and 1716 is also connected to a corresponding second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branch 1701', 1702', 1703', 1704', 1705', 1706', 1714', 1715' and 1716'.
- the primary ring 1713 extends around the floor adjacent the perimeter of the floor, while each of the primary ring second wiring network branches 1701', 1702', 1703', 1704', 1705' and 1706' extend along a respective portion of the perimeter of the building floor.
- the secondary ring 1720 extends around the center of the floor, within the primary ring 1713, as do each of the secondary ring second wiring network branches 1714', 1715' and 1716'.
- the design of the network topology in Fig. 17B is similar to that of the embodiment shown in Fig. 17A.
- the first wiring primary ring 1713 and the first wiring secondary ring 1720 connect the distributed control panels on the rings to the building Ethernet network for (e.g., high-speed) data communication purposes, while the second wiring network branches placed around the rings can connect the various distributed control panels to the branch devices for the supply of both electrical power and data.
- each distributed control panel node in the primary ring 1713 shown in Fig. 17B is accessible by at least two different first wiring (e.g., fiber optics) paths due to the network ring topology.
- Each distributed control panel node in the secondary ring 1720 is also accessible by at least two different first wiring paths. Accordingly, through the use of network protocols such as Spanning Tree Protocol (STP), it is possible to build fault-tolerance redundancy into the floor network.
- STP Spanning Tree Protocol
- a given node in the primary ring 1713 develops a fault which hinders (e.g., prevents) communication of signals through that node
- communication with neighboring nodes on the primary ring is not prevented as each node can be reached via an alternative path.
- a given node in the secondary ring 1720 develops a fault which hinders (e.g., prevents) communication of signals through that node
- communication with neighboring nodes on the secondary ring is not hindered (e.g., prevented) as each node can be reached via an alternative path.
- first wiring links 1721 and 1722 between the primary and secondary rings ensures that nodes in the secondary ring remain reachable no matter where a fault occurs in the primary ring (even if it occurs at node forming a network connection to the secondary ring), and vice versa.
- the first wiring links 1721 and 1722 also ensure that each node in the secondary ring is reachable no matter where a fault occurs in the secondary ring, even if it is at a distributed control panel which is connected directly to the primary ring. Accordingly, the embodiment shown in Fig. 17B has increased fault tolerance redundancy and therefore increased reliability.
- this multi-access topology can provide more reliable antenna coverage over entire floor. Thus, wireless communications such as cellular, Wi-Fi, and Bluetooth are less likely to be disrupted if a head end or link malfunctions (e.g., goes down).
- a physical network topology for a floor 1800 of a building includes distributed control panels 1801 , 1802, 1803, 1804, 1805, 1806, 1807, 1808 and 1809 connected to one another in series by segments of first wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cable) 1810, 1811 , 1812, 1813, 1814, 1815, 1816, 1817, 1818 and 1819.
- Distributed control panels 1801 , 1802, 1803, 1804, 1805 and 1806 form nodes of an exterior first wiring ring 1820 which extends around the floor adjacent the perimeter of the floor.
- Distributed control panels 1801 , 1804, 1807, 1808 and 1809 form nodes in a first wiring network chord which links opposing sides of the exterior ring 1820. Accordingly, it is possible to define two sub-rings within the floor network: a first sub-ring connecting distributed control panels 1801 , 1802, 1803, 1804, 1807, 1808 and 1809; and a second sub-ring connecting distributed control panels 1801 , 1804, 1805, 1806, 1807, 1808 and 1809. Each distributed control panel 1801 , 1802, 1803, 1804, 1805, 1806, 1807, 1808 and 1809 is connected to a corresponding second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) network branch 1801', 1802', 1803', 1804',
- a second wiring e.g., coaxial cable
- the design of the network topology in Fig. 18 is similar to that of the preceding embodiments in that the first wiring connect the distributed control panels to the building Ethernet network for (e.g., high-speed) data communication purposes, while the second wiring network branches connect the distributed control panels to the branch devices for the supply of both electrical power and communication signal (e.g., data).
- Each distributed control panel node in the network shown in Fig. 18 is accessible by at least two different first wiring (e.g., fiber optic) paths due to the interconnected network ring topology. Accordingly, through the use of network protocols such as Spanning Tree Protocol (STP), it is possible to build fault-tolerance redundancy into the floor network.
- STP Spanning Tree Protocol
- the embodiment shown in Fig. 18 can achieve greater overall fault-tolerance redundancy, and therefore higher reliability, than the embodiment of Fig. 17A, and it achieves similar levels of reliability in comparison to the embodiment of Fig. 17B, although with a reduction in the total length of first wiring required.
- each node in the network (such as each distributed control panel node in the networks shown in Figs. 16A, 17A, 17B, or 10) includes two or more distributed control panels, each containing headends connecting the respective first wiring (e.g., fiber optic) rings to the second wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) branch lines.
- first wiring e.g., fiber optic
- second wiring e.g., coaxial cable
- a connection between each branch line and the first wiring network would be maintained even if a distributed control panel (e.g. a headend) were to develop a fault.
- branch devices provide communications connectivity (such as connections to external cellular networks).
- FIG. 16A-18 The embodiments of Figs. 16A-18, as well as related embodiments employing a ring topology, may provide redundancy and availability. If one control panel, headend, or data link malfunctions (e.g., goes down), most of the devices on the network remain available.
- Figs. 16A-18 and related embodiments may be relatively simple to install.
- the network components of an outer ring is first installed and then the network components of an inner ring is installed, or vice versa.
- some or all of the second wiring e.g., coaxial cable
- the second wiring is RG-11 coaxial cable.
- control panels employed in ring topology embodiments comprise network components in various combination options such as (a) electrical power supplies integrated with communications node having communications components such as network switches (same enclosure) or (b) separate electrical power supply and communications node (different enclosures) (e.g., installed at the same location).
- control panels provide DC Power and communications to downstream devices such as window controllers and digital architectural elements.
- the DC power may be provided with at least about 2 Watts (W), 4W, or 20W.
- Fiber optic cabling can enable data transmission at rates of, e.g., at least about 100 Gbit/s, per channel, over large distances (e.g. over at least about 10 km).
- Each fiber optic ring may contain multiple individual optical fibers, e.g., to provide necessary bandwidth and/or further fault-tolerance redundancy.
- Armored fiber optic cabling such as fiber optic cabling wrapped in aluminum armor, may be used to provide physical protection and/or crush resistance.
- the types of coaxial cable used in the coaxial cable network branches may be selected based at least in part on the electrical power supply and/or communication rate needs of the branch devices.
- the branch lines of each coaxial network branch are formed using RG-11 coaxial cables.
- RG-11 coaxial cables are able to support at least about 24V, Class 2, DC power supplies.
- the conductive lines of RG-11 coaxial cables can be sufficiently thick that the branch lines exhibit low losses and can carry high electrical powers.
- the loss-per-foot of RG-11 coaxial cable can be at most about one tenth the loss-per-foot of thinner RG-6 coaxial cable.
- different types of coaxial cable can be used to form the branch lines in other embodiments.
- the coaxial cable drop lines may be formed using RG-6 coaxial cables.
- RG-6 coaxial cables are thinner and more flexible than RG-11 coaxial cables and may be more suited to supplying electrical power to individual branch devices.
- the types of coaxial cable used to form the drop lines may be varied.
- RG-6 coaxial cable drop lines connect the device controllers to RG-11 coaxial cable branch lines, while M8 cables connect the device controllers to the branch devices.
- Smaller diameter coaxial cables serving as drop lines may be connected to larger diameter coaxial cables serving as branch lines by taps.
- RG-6 coaxial cable drop lines can be connected to RG-11 coaxial cable branch lines, e.g., by distribution junctions (e.g., taps).
- the taps may be inductive taps which transfer electrical power between the branch lines and the drop lines, e.g., without achieving a direct conductive path between the branch and drop lines.
- a distribution junction e.g., tap
- Distribution junctions may be employed on trunk line to deliver (e.g., electrical and/or communication signal) power to the drop lines.
- a distribution junction e.g., tap
- a small amount e.g., a fraction less than a half
- 0.5 W per tap For example, if a trunk line delivers 15 W to a tap, and 14.5 W of that power is available downstream on the trunk line, 0.5 W shunted to the device via the drop line.
- a small amount may be less than about 0.1 , 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.4, or 0.5 times the electrical power and/or communication signal power.
- the cabling system e.g., distribution junction
- the cabling system may couple to the power, e.g., to replenish diminishing power in the cabling system, for example, to facilitate additional power injection downstream of a floor controller.
- the distribution junction is passive.
- the distribution junction is dynamic.
- the distribution junction may comprise a dynamic element such as a control circuitry (e.g., micro-controller).
- the dynamic element may signal (e.g., the control system) when there is a foreseeable (e.g., imminent) power depletion (e.g., that may necessitate replenishing electrical power to continue activating a target).
- the dynamic element may facilitate power negotiation.
- the dynamic element may identify a coupling target (e.g., device) prior to its full coupling to the network (e.g., by probing the target device on connection).
- the dynamic element may incorporate power negotiation algorithm (e.g., will consider present and/or forecasted power distribution in the cabling system).
- the power negotiation may comprise a PoE standard that may specify automatic negotiation between client (e.g., target through local controller) and master (e.g., upper hierarchy controller, e.g., in the control panel of the floor).
- client e.g., target through local controller
- master e.g., upper hierarchy controller, e.g., in the control panel of the floor
- the target device e.g., client
- the master e.g., controller
- the master e.g., controller
- the cabling system may comprise device(s) that (i) measure (e.g., DC) voltage along the length of the trunk line, (ii) provide feedback to the control panel and/or other devices, and/or (iii) monitor and/or compensate for excessive voltage drops from loads at greater distances from electrical (e.g., DC) power injection.
- the maximum power transmitted by the cabling system may follow any International Electrotechnical Commission (I EC) class.
- the I EC class can be a 0, I, II, or III I EC class.
- the cabling system may abide by class II of IEC, having maximum 100VA.
- the distribution voltage of the DC power can be at least about 12V, 24V, or 48V DC.
- the distribution junction may facilitate transmission of communication signals.
- the cabling system e.g., comprising the distribution junction as part of the cabling system
- the signal filter(s) can be disposed downstream of the targets (e.g., devices), such as (e.g., 4G or 5G) antennas, such as those that utilize higher frequencies.
- the filter(s) may or may not be integral to the distribution junction.
- the filter(s) may be integrated on the downstream bus leg of a distribution junction.
- the filter(s) may be external to (e.g., and operatively coupled to) a distribution junction.
- the network may utilize Power over Ethernet (PoE) and/or VLAN signaling, e.g., between the (e.g., micro) controller and the target device, e.g., to Authenticate the (e.g., 3 rd party) device and/or its power consumption.
- PoE Power over Ethernet
- VLAN signaling e.g., between the (e.g., micro) controller and the target device, e.g., to Authenticate the (e.g., 3 rd party) device and/or its power consumption.
- LLDP Link Layer Discovery Protocol
- the distribution junction may comprise a system facilitating a repeater, range extender, and/or signal transponder functions, such as a radio frequency (RF) power distributor.
- the distribution junction may be passive (e.g., including capacitor(s), inductor(s), and/or transformer(s)).
- a plurality of devices is operatively coupled (e.g., communicatively and/or physically coupled) to the network.
- the network may be a local network of a facility. At times, at least one of the devices may require electrical power that exceeds the capacity of the network (or of a branch of the network). When such request is satisfied, the network (or a branch of the network) may be disabled.
- the network may comprise one or more shutters, switches, or power managers.
- the power manager may comprise a controller.
- the switch may comprise a manual or an automatic switch.
- the shutter may comprise an automatic or manual shutter.
- the switch may be an on/off switch.
- the on/off switch may (e.g., temporarily) disconnect a device requesting an excessive amount of electrical power (e.g., above a threshold) from the network, e.g., to prevent a collapse of the network or of a portion of the network.
- the power manager may manage electrical power request of various devices to (i) prevent power drainage from the network, (ii) allow a maximum number of devices to operate at their intended mode.
- the maximum number of devices may or may not consider any hierarchy of device operation. For example, devices crucial to safe operation of the facility, health of the facility occupants, and/or operating core functions of the facility, may receive priority over other devices.
- the network may transmit direct current (DC) electrical current.
- the electrical current may be of class 2 (e.g., having about 100Watts, about 2Amp, and about 48Volts) DC current transmission.
- the commercially available device(s) may be configured for transmission of DC current in a milliamp range (e.g., a current of at most about 0.1 mA, 1 mA, 10mA, or 100mA).
- the cabling network is configured to transmit electrical power and communication signal.
- the network may comprise a television (TV) related network.
- the network may be configured to transmit media (e.g., video, stills, movies, or television) communication.
- the network may be configured to transmit targeted communication (e.g., commercials and/or alerts).
- the network e.g., cable thereof
- the network may be configured to transmit electrical signal (e.g., DC current) while providing low-noise communication of a communication (e.g., RF) signal.
- the cabling network may be configured for minimal distortion of the RF signal passing through the cabling system, e.g., and through the distribution junction that joins various cables of the cabling system.
- a problem may arise when an excessive electrical (e.g., DC) current causes oversaturation of inductors that are part of the distribution junction. This may cause reduction in quality of the communication signal passing thorough the inductor, e.g., due to attenuation (e.g., lower amplitude of signal), distortion (e.g., alters frequency of the signal), and/or crosstalk (e.g., signal in one frequency transferred to another frequency).
- attenuation e.g., lower amplitude of signal
- distortion e.g., alters frequency of the signal
- crosstalk e.g., signal in one frequency transferred to another frequency.
- the end-to-end attenuation of the communication (e.g., RF) signal transmitted through the trunk line should not be too high.
- High may be defined with respect to the saturation current of the inductor, and/or with respect to the current required to reach a certain level of harmonic distortion of the communication (e.g., RF) signal.
- the inductor should preferably remain in its linear transfer regime.
- the inductor should preferably be in a non-saturated condition.
- the signal attenuation by the distribution junction should be such that the signal will be strong enough to communicate with the device(s) connect to the tap line, and travel through a maximum number of distribution junctions along the trunk line (e.g., and still be able to communicate with the last device coupled to the last distribution junction along the trunk line).
- the power of the communication (e.g., RF) signal at the circuitry portion of the distribution junction dedicated to the branch is attenuated at a level from about -20dB to about -26dB of the communication signal power transmitted at the trunk line (e.g., from about 1 ⁇ 4% to about 1% of the communication (e.g., RF) signal power transmitted at the trunk line).
- the communication e.g., RF
- the power of the communication (e.g., RF) signal at the circuitry portion of the distribution junction that is dedicated to the branch is attenuated to a level that facilitates connection of at least about 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 21 , 14, 16, 20, 30, 32, 50, 60, or 64 distribution junctions along the trunk line (e.g., identical distribution junctions along the trunk line).
- the power of the communication (e.g., RF) signal at the circuitry portion of the distribution junction that is dedicated to the branch is attenuated to a level that facilitates connection of at least about 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 21 , 14, 16, 20, 30, 32, 50, 60, or 64 devices along the trunk line.
- the power of the communication (e.g., RF) signal at the circuitry portion of the distribution junction that is dedicated to the branch is attenuated to a level that facilitates connection of at least about 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 21 , 14, 16, 20, 30, 32, 50, 60, or 64 branch lines along the trunk line, (e.g., see Fig. 23).
- the distribution junction is configured to minimize crosstalk between the communication signals transmitted in the trunk line and the communication signals transmitted to the branch line (e.g., to the tap line).
- the distribution junction may comprise a directional distribution junction capable of transmitting communication (e.g., RF) signals and electrical (e.g., DC) power, which distribution junction may be configured to sustain a higher electrical current as compared to a distribution junction that is not a directional distribution junction.
- the directional coupler may provide an electrical power passing coupler that is configured to send most of the communication signal through the trunk line (e.g., connected to the control system), while providing sufficient (decipherable) communication signal to one or more devices connected to (e.g., tapped to) the distribution junction.
- the distribution junction may or may not offer impedance matching.
- the distribution junction can have at least 1 , 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 branch lines (e.g., taps).
- the distribution junction can be a single drop coupler or a multidrop coupler.
- Type of distribution junction utilized may depend on installation configuration.
- the distribution junction can be configured for a Linear Ethernet type network.
- the fundamental length scale (FLS) of the distribution junction can be at most about 0.25 inch (“), 0.5”, 0.75”, 1”, 1 .25”, 1 .5”, 1 .75”, or 2.0”.
- the FLS of the distribution junction can be of any value between the aforementioned values (e.g., from about 0.25” to about 2.0”, from about 0.25” to about 1”, from about 0.75” to about 1 .25”, or from about 1” to about 2”).
- the distribution junction comprises a switch.
- the switch may comprise an automatically resetting thermal switch (e.g., fuse).
- the switch may be incorporated into the circuitry of the distribution junction.
- the switch may comprise a Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) switch.
- PTC Positive Temperature Coefficient
- the switch may be triggered by a temperature increase above a threshold.
- the PTC can be included in the branching (e.g., tapping) portion of the circuitry.
- the switch may be a reset switch.
- the switch may be configured such that once electrical power is taken from the switch, the PTC returns to its original state (e.g., reset the switch).
- the switch may be configured to allow electrical (e.g., DC) power and communication (e.g., RF) signals to travel through the trunk line, e.g., during a temporary opening of the switch (e.g., that disables connection of the distribution junction to the branch line (e.g., tap line).
- the PTC switch may be implemented using a thermally-activated electromechanical on-off switch, an electromechanical thermal cutoff switch, a self-activated thermal switch, a mechanical thermal switch, a bimetallic temperature control switch, a fluid- filled temperature control switch, a digital temperature control switch, an electronic thermal switch, a thermal protector, or any switch, fuse, or link that is self-resetting after a thermal event has taken place.
- the switch may comprise a resistor such as a thermistor.
- the switch may comprise a positive (e.g., PTC) or a negative (e.g., NTC) temperature coefficient resistor (e.g., thermistor).
- the switch may comprise a semiconductor (e.g., metal oxide).
- the switch may comprise polycrystalline ceramic (e.g., doped polycrystalline ceramic such as, e.g., BaTiO 3 ).
- the switch may comprise a material whose resistance rises suddenly at a certain critical temperature.
- the switch may comprise a thermally sensitive silicon resistor.
- the switch may be a passive or a dynamic switch.
- the switch may comprise a fuse.
- the switch may comprise a polymer (e.g., a polyswitch). In some embodiments, when a current flows through the switch, it may generate heat, which may raise a temperature of the switch, e.g., above the ambient environment temperature. The switch may act as a protection circuity element
- the cabling system comprises a distribution junction.
- the distribution junction may be configured to distribute electrical power and communication (e.g., RF) power.
- the electrical power can be provided as a direct current (e.g., DC).
- the distribution junction may include a first port (e.g., an input port) configured for receiving communication and electrical power (e.g., RF power and DC power) from an upstream circuit.
- the distribution junction can include a second port (e.g., an output port) configured for distributing the communication and electrical power (e.g., RF power and the DC power) to a downstream circuit.
- the distribution junction may include a third port (e.g., a coupled port) configured for distributing the communication and electrical power (e.g., RF power and the DC power) to a branch circuit (e.g., operatively coupled to a target device).
- a third port e.g., a coupled port
- electrical power e.g., RF power and the DC power
- Fig. 19 shows an example of an electronic schematic of an example of a distribution junction 1900. It may be noted that other examples of distribution junctions were discussed herein, e.g., in connection with Fig. 3.
- the distribution junction 1900 is configured to distribute electrical power and communication (e.g., RF) power.
- the electrical power can be provided as a direct current (DC).
- the distribution junction 1900 may include a first port 1930 (e.g., an input port) configured for receiving communication and electrical power (e.g., RF power and DC power) from an upstream circuit.
- the distribution junction 1900 includes a second port 1931 (e.g., an output port) configured for distributing the communication and electrical power (e.g., RF power and the DC power) to a downstream circuit.
- the distribution junction 1900 includes a third port 1933 (e.g., a coupled port) configured for distributing the communication and electrical power (e.g., RF power and the DC power) to a branch circuit (e.g., operatively coupled to a target device).
- the distribution junction 1900 includes a first (DC) blocking capacitor 1902, a second (DC) blocking capacitor 1904, a third (DC) blocking capacitor 1906, a first series inductor 1908, a third series inductor 1910, a second series inductor 1912, a matched load 1914, a directional coupler 1916, an input port 1941 , a transmitted port 1942, a coupled port 1943, and an isolated port 1944.
- the distribution junction may include a first circuit path for distributing the communication (e.g., RF) power, and a second circuit path for distributing the electrical (e.g., DC) power.
- the first circuit path may operate as follows:
- a first electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor can be operatively coupled (e.g., in series) between the first port of the distribution junction and an input port of a directional coupler.
- a second electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor can be operatively coupled (e.g., in series) between the second port of the distribution junction and a transmitted port of the directional coupler.
- a third electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor can be coupled between the third port of the distribution junction and a coupled port of the directional coupler.
- the directional coupler may include one or more (e.g., RF) transformers.
- the (e.g., RF) transformers may comprise coil windings that are disposed in proximity to ferrite material.
- Communication (e.g., RF) power may be applied to the first port of the distribution junction.
- At least some (e.g., all or most) of the applied communication (e.g., RF) power can pass through the first electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor, and reach the input port of the directional coupler.
- a first portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port may be outputted by the transmitted port, passing through the second DC blocking capacitor and then outputted by the second port of the distribution junction.
- a second portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port may be outputted by the coupled port.
- the second portion can be the difference between the communication (e.g.,
- RF radio frequency
- the distribution junction comprises an isolated port (e.g., 1944).
- the directional coupler can be symmetric, with an isolated port (e.g., a fourth port) being provided. At least a portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the transmitted port may appear at the isolated port.
- the directional coupler may not be used in this mode, and the isolated port may be terminated with a matched load (e.g., a resistor of at least a 50-ohm or 75-ohm). Such termination can be internal to the directional coupler, and /or the distribution junction, e.g., whereby the isolated port may not be accessible to the user.
- the distribution junction facilitates electrical power distribution.
- the second circuit path may operate as follows: Electrical (e.g., DC) current applied to the first port may be distributed to the second port through a first series inductor (e.g., 1908) and a second series inductor (e.g., DC) current applied to the first port may be distributed to the second port through a first series inductor (e.g., 1908) and a second series inductor (e.g., DC) current applied to the first port may be distributed to the second port through a first series inductor (e.g., 1908) and a second series inductor (e.g., DC) current applied to the first port may be distributed to the second port through a first series inductor (e.g., 1908) and a second series inductor (e.g., DC) current applied to the first port may be distributed to the second port through a first series inductor (e.g., 1908) and a second series inductor (e.
- Electrical (e.g., DC) current applied to the first port may be distributed to the third port through the first series inductor (e.g., 1908) and a third series inductor (e.g., 1910), or any combination thereof.
- the first series inductor (e.g., 1908), the second series inductor (e.g., 1912), and the third series inductor (e.g., 1910), or any combination thereof may be selected to have a high impedance across a range of frequencies corresponding to the communication (e.g., RF) power applied to the first port.
- the range of frequencies of the communication signal may comprise one or more frequency components indicative of amplitude as a function of frequency for one or more discrete frequencies, or for one or more discrete bandwidths of frequencies.
- the frequency components may include (i) a lowest frequency component, (ii) a highest frequency component, or (iii) a lowest frequency component and a highest frequency component.
- the electrical power can be provided as DC current.
- the electrical power can be provided as an alternating current (AC).
- the AC can be a periodically-varying current at a frequency lower than the lowest frequency component(s) of the communication (e.g., RF) power.
- the AC electrical power can be a periodically-varying current at a frequency higher than the highest frequency component(s) of the communication (e.g., RF) power.
- the reactances of the first series inductor, the second series inductor, the third series inductor, first DC blocking capacitor, second DC blocking capacitor, and/or the third DC blocking capacitor can be selected such that at least a (e.g., major, or substantial) portion of the electrical power (e.g., AC or DC) passes through the inductor(s), e.g., while at least a (e.g., major, or substantial) portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power passes through the capacitor(s).
- a signal (e.g., low-pass) filter can be substituted for any of the first series inductor (e.g., 1908), the second series inductor (e.g., 1912), and/or the third series inductor (e.g., 1910).
- a signal (e.g., high-pass) filter can be substituted for the first DC blocking capacitor (e.g., 1902), the second DC blocking capacitor (e.g., 1904), and/or the third DC blocking capacitor (e.g., 1906).
- one or more signal filters may be added to the electronic circuitry of the distribution junction.
- the filter(s) can include high pass filer and/or low pass filter.
- the distribution junctions housed in a housing e.g., casing.
- the casing may have a plurality of connectors (e.g., at least 2, 3, 4, 5, 7, 8, 9, 10, or more connectors).
- the connectors may be ports. At least two of the plurality of connectors may connect the distribution junction to the bus line (e.g., main line). At least one of the distribution junction connectors may connect the distribution junction to a branch line (e.g., operatively coupled to at least one device).
- the connectors may be configured to connect to a cable or wire (e.g., a coaxial cable).
- the connectors may be configured for transmittal of electrical and communication signal (e.g., transmitted on the wire or cable).
- the housing may comprise an insulating material (e.g., a polymer or a resin).
- the housing may comprise an elemental metal, a metal alloy, a ceramic, or an allotrope of elemental metal.
- the housing may comprise a transparent or an opaque material.
- the housing may facilitate dissipation of heat from its interior.
- the housing may be configured to facilitate its coupling and/or attachment to a fixture (e.g., a wall or a framing).
- the housing may comprise one or more incisions or protrusions that facilitate its coupling and/or attachment to a fixture (e.g., a wall or a framing).
- the housing may be configured to secure the electronic circuitry of the junction, e.g., from external influences (e.g., physical damage, water damage, corrosion, and/or heating).
- the housing may facilitate coupling of wires(s) and/or cable(s) to the electronic circuitry in the distribution junction, e.g., via connectors (e.g., ports).
- the ports may include an input port, a transmit port, a coupled port, or any combination or plurality thereof.
- Fig. 20 depicts various illustrative mechanical housing portions and ports related to a first distribution junction 2000, a second distribution junction 2030, and a third distribution junction 2060.
- the first distribution junction 2000 may include a first port 2001 (corresponding, for example, to the first port 1930 of Fig. 19), a second port 2002 (corresponding, for example, to the second port 1931 of Fig. 19), and a third port 2003 (corresponding, for example, to the third port 1933 of Fig. 19).
- the first port 2001 (Fig. 20) may function as an input port
- the second port 2002 may function as a transmit port
- the third port 2003 may function as a coupled port.
- a first portion of the communication e.g.,
- RF radio frequency
- the first port 2001 e.g., the input port
- the second port 2002 e.g., the transmitted port
- a second portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power applied to the first port 2001 can be outputted by the third port 2003 (e.g., the coupled port).
- the second portion may be the difference between the communication (e.g., RF) power applied to the first port 2001 , minus the communication (e.g., RF) power that is outputted by the second port 2002.
- the distribution junction may comprise at least a first port, a second port, and a third port.
- the first port (e.g., 2001) and the third port (e.g., 2003) can be situated (for example) side-by-side at a first end of a distribution junction (e.g., 2000), with the second port (e.g., 2002) being situated at a second end of the distribution junction opposite the first end.
- the first, second, and third ports may be provided, for example, using male BNC connectors, female BNC jacks, male N connectors, female N jacks, male F connectors, female F jacks, male SMA connectors, female SMA jacks, male TNG connectors, female TNG jacks, various other types of connectors, various other types of jacks, and/or any of various combinations thereof.
- the first distribution junction may be housed in a metal enclosure. In some embodiments, the first distribution junction may be housed in a non-metallic structure.
- the housing portions and ports related to a second distribution junction 2030 includes a first port 2011 (corresponding, for example, to the first port 1930 of Fig. 19), a second port 2012 (corresponding, for example, to the second port 1931 of Fig. 19), and a third port 2013 (corresponding, for example, to the third port 1933 of Fig. 19).
- the first port may function as an input port
- the second port may function as a transmit port
- the third port may function as a coupled port.
- the first port can be situated at a first end of the distribution junction
- the third port can be situated at a second end of the distribution junction opposite the first end (e.g., see 2030 of Fig. 20).
- housing portions and ports related to the third distribution junction 2060 includes a first port 2021 (corresponding, for example, to the first port 1930 of Fig. 19), a second port 2022 (corresponding, for example, to the second port 1931 of Fig. 19), and a third port 2023 (corresponding, for example, to the third port 1933 of Fig. 19).
- the first port may function as an input port
- the second port may function as a transmit port
- the third port may function as a coupled port.
- the first port can be situated at a first end of the distribution junction.
- the second and third ports respectively, can be situated at a second end of the distribution junction opposite the first end (e.g., see 2060 of Fig. 20).
- Fig. 21 depicts an illustrative mechanical configuration for a housing portions and ports related to distribution junction 2100 (corresponding, for example, to the third distribution junction 2060 of Fig. 20).
- the distribution junction 2100 includes a first port 2106 (corresponding to the first port 2021 of Fig. 20), a second port 2102 (corresponding to the second port 2022 of Fig. 20), and a third port 2103 (corresponding to the third port 2023 of Fig. 20).
- the distribution junction is connected to a plurality of branch lines, e.g., as disclosed herein. At least one electrical element of the distribution junction may repeat for each branch. For example, at connector to the branch, an inductor (e.g., series inductor), and/or a switch may be dedicated for a branch. At least one branch dedicated circuity portion of the distribution junction circuitry may comprise a switch. At least one branch dedicated circuity portion of the distribution junction circuitry may be devoid of a switch. At least one element of the electronic circuitry is common to a plurality of tap branch circuit portions, e.g., an inductor.
- an inductor e.g., series inductor
- the distribution junction circuitry comprises a plurality of electronic components.
- the plurality of electronic components may comprise at least one wire, port, directional coupler, capacitor, coupler (e.g., directional couplers), matched load, inductor (e.g., series inductor), or a switch.
- the ports may comprise an input port, an output port, a transmitted port, or an isolated port.
- the port may be configured for distributing the communication power and the electrical power a downstream and/or upstream circuit.
- the port may be a mono or bi-directional port.
- the capacitors may comprise an electrical power blocking capacitor.
- the matched load may having an impedance value that results in maximum absorption of energy from the signal source.
- the distribution junction may be configured for impedance matching.
- the distribution junction may be configured to maximize the electrical power transfer.
- the distribution junction may be configured to maximize the signal to noise ratio.
- the distribution junction may be configured to minimize signal reflection from the load.
- Fig. 22 shows an electronic schematic of a distribution junction 2200 circuitry.
- the distribution junction 2200 is a cascaded version of the distribution junction 1900 described herein, e.g., with reference to Fig. 19.
- the distribution junction 2200 may be configured to distribute electrical power and communication (e.g., RF) power.
- the electrical power may be provided as a direct current (DC).
- the distribution junction 2200 includes a first port 2230 (e.g., an input port) configured for receiving communication (e.g., RF) power and electrical (e.g., DC) power from an upstream circuit.
- the distribution junction 2200 includes a second port 2231 (e.g., an output port) configured for distributing the communication power and the electrical power to a downstream circuit.
- the distribution junction 2200 includes a third port 2233 (e.g., a first coupled port) and a fourth port 2234 (e.g., a second coupled port).
- the third port 2233 and/or the fourth port 2234 can be configured for distributing the communication power and the electrical power to at least one branch circuit.
- the distribution junction 2200 includes a first directional coupler 2216 in cascade with a second directional coupler 2236.
- the third port and/or the fourth port may be each configured to operatively coupled to one or more target devices.
- the distribution junction 2200 includes a first electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor 2202 operatively coupled in series between the first port 2230 and an input port 2241 of the first directional coupler 2216.
- the distribution junction 2200 includes an input port 2241 of the first directional coupler 2216, a transmitted port 2242 of the first directional coupler 2216, an input port 2251 of the second directional coupler 2236, a transmitted port 2252 of the second directional coupler 2236, a second electrical power (DC) blocking capacitor 2204, a third electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor 2206 coupled between the third port 2233 of the distribution junction 2200 and the coupled port 2243 of the first directional coupler 2216, a port 2243 of the first directional coupler 2216, a transmitted port 2242, a fourth electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor 2246 coupled between a fourth port 2234 and coupled port 2253 of the second directional coupler 2236, an input port 2251 of the second directional coupler
- the distribution junction may include a first circuit path for distributing the communication power, and a second circuit path for distributing the electrical power.
- the first circuit path may operate as follows: Communication power may be applied to the first port of the distribution junction.
- a first electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor may be operatively coupled in series between a first port and an input port of the first directional coupler. All or most of the RF applied to the first port may reach the input port of the first directional coupler.
- a first portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port can be outputted by the transmitted port of the first directional coupler, reaching an input port of the second directional coupler.
- a first portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port can be outputted by the transmitted port of the second directional coupler. All or most of the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the transmitted port may pass through the second electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor and can be outputted by the second port of the distribution junction.
- a third electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor (e.g., 2206) may be coupled between the third port (e.g., 2233) of the distribution junction and the coupled port (e.g., 2243) of the first directional coupler (e.g., 2216).
- a second portion of the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port (e.g., 2241) of the first directional coupler may be outputted by the coupled port of the first directional coupler.
- the second portion at the coupled port can be the difference between the communication (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port, minus the communication (e.g., RF) power that is outputted by the transmitted port (e.g., 2242).
- At least a portion (e.g., all or most) of the second portion at the coupled port may pass through the third electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor and reach the third port (e.g., 2233) of the distribution junction.
- DC electrical power
- the communication signal (e.g., RF) power at the third port can be used by one or more downstream devices on one or more branch circuits.
- a fourth electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor (e.g., 2246) may be coupled between the fourth port (e.g., 2234) of the distribution junction and the coupled port (e.g., 2253) of the second directional coupler (e.g., 2236).
- a second portion of the communication signal (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port (e.g., 2251) of the second directional coupler can be outputted by the coupled port of the second directional coupler.
- the second portion at the coupled port may be the difference between the communication signal (e.g., RF) power reaching the input port, minus the communication signal (e.g., RF) power that is outputted by the transmitted port. At least a portion (e.g., all or most) of the second portion at the coupled port may pass through the fourth electrical power (e.g., DC) blocking capacitor and reach the fourth port of the distribution junction.
- the communication signal (e.g., RF) power at the fourth port can be used by one or more downstream devices on one or more branch circuits.
- the directional coupler may include one or more communication signal (e.g., RF) transformers.
- the communication signal (e.g., RF) transformers may comprise coil windings that are disposed in proximity to ferrite material.
- the first directional coupler e.g., 2216
- an isolated port such as 2244 (e.g., a fourth port) may be provided.
- a portion of the communication signal (e.g., RF) power reaching the transmitted port will appear at the isolated port.
- the first directional coupler may not be used in this mode, and the isolated port (e.g., 2244) may be terminated with a matched load such as 2214 (e.g., having resistance of at least about 50-ohm or 75-ohm).
- This termination can be internal to the first directional coupler, and/or to the distribution junction, whereby the isolated port may not be accessible to the user.
- the second directional coupler can be symmetric, with an isolated port such as 2254 (e.g., a fourth port) being provided.
- a portion of the communication signal (e.g., RF) power reaching the transmitted port (e.g., 2252) may appear at the isolated port (e.g., 2254).
- the second directional coupler may not be used in this mode, and the isolated port may be terminated with a matched load such as 2226 (e.g., having resistance of at least about 50-ohm or 75-ohm).
- a matched load such as 2226 (e.g., having resistance of at least about 50-ohm or 75-ohm).
- Such termination can be internal to the second directional coupler, and/or to the distribution junction, e.g., whereby the isolated port may not be accessible to the user.
- the distribution junction facilitated electrical power distribution comprising a first circuity path and a second circuity path.
- electrical e.g.,
- the second circuit path may operate as follows: electrical current applied to the first port can be distributed to the second port through a first series inductor (e.g., 2208) and a second series inductor (e.g., 2222). Electrical current applied to the first port (e.g., 2230) can be distributed to a third port (e.g., 2233) through the first series inductor, a first automatically-resetting current-limiting cutoff switch (e.g., 2212), and a third series inductor (e.g., 2210).
- a first series inductor e.g. 2208
- a second series inductor e.g., 2222
- Electrical current applied to the first port e.g., 2230
- a third port e.g., 2233
- a first automatically-resetting current-limiting cutoff switch e.g., 2212
- a third series inductor e.g., 2210
- Electrical current applied to the first port can be distributed to the fourth port (e.g., 2234) through the first series inductor, a second automatically-resetting current-limiting cutoff switch (e.g., 2228), and a fourth series inductor (e.g., 2220).
- the first series inductor, the second series inductor, the third series inductor and the fourth series inductor may be selected to have a high impedance across a range of frequencies corresponding to the communication signal power applied to the first port.
- the range of frequencies may comprise one or more frequency components indicative of amplitude as a function of frequency for one or more discrete frequencies, or for one or more discrete bandwidths of frequencies.
- the frequency components may include a lowest frequency component and/or a highest frequency component.
- the electrical power can be provided as electrical current.
- the electrical power can be provided as an alternating current (AC).
- the AC can be a periodically-varying current at a frequency lower than the lowest frequency component(s) of the RF power.
- the AC electrical power can be a periodically-varying current at a frequency higher than the highest frequency component(s) of the communication signal power.
- the reactances of the first series inductor e.g., 2208), second series inductor (e.g., 2222), third series inductor (e.g., 2210), fourth series inductor (e.g., 2220), first electrical power blocking capacitor (e.g., 2202), second electrical power blocking capacitor (e.g., 2204), third DC blocking capacitor 2206 and fourth electrical power blocking capacitor (e.g., 2246) can be selected so that at least a (e.g., substantial) portion of the electrical (e.g., AC or DC) power passes through these inductors, e.g., while at least a (e.g., substantial) portion of the communication signal power passes through these capacitors.
- the electrical e.g., AC or DC
- the distribution junction includes at least one switch.
- the switch can be an automatically resetting switch.
- the switch can be a current limiting switch.
- the switch may protect the circuitry and/or device from malfunction e.g., (i) due to supply of harmful amount of electrical current, (ii) due to request of excessive amount of electrical current by the device(s), (iii) due to excessive temperature, or (iv) any combination of (i), (ii), and (iii).
- the switch may protect the circuitry and/or device from malfunction e.g., due to overheating.
- the distribution junction may comprise an automatically-resetting current-limiting switch.
- the distribution junction may comprise a plurality of switches.
- the distribution junction may comprise a switch prior to the port configured for coupling one or more devices and/or branch lines to the distribution junction.
- the first (e.g., automatically-resetting current-limiting cutoff) switch e.g., 2212
- the first (e.g., automatically-resetting current-limiting cutoff) switch e.g., 2212) may provide protection against any device(s) that would otherwise drain an excessive amount of electrical current from the port (e.g., third port 2233).
- a second (e.g., automatically-resetting current- limiting cutoff) switch (e.g., 2228) or any other additional switch can provide protection against any device or devices that would otherwise drain an excessive amount of electrical current from the port to which it is coupled (e.g., a fourth port 2234).
- the switch(es) can comprise: (i) thermally-activated electromechanical on-off switches, (ii) electromechanical on-off switches, (iii) electromechanical thermal cutoff switches, (iv) self-actuated thermal switches, (v) mechanical thermal switches, bimetallic temperature control switches, (vi) fluid- filled temperature control switches, (vii) digital temperature control switches, (viii) electronic thermal switches, (ix) thermal protectors, or (x) any switch, fuse, or link that is self-resetting after an (e.g., thermal or electrical) event has taken place.
- the cutoff switch(es) can be automatically-resetting thermal switches, fuses, circuit breakers, or positive temperature coefficient (PTC) switches.
- the switch may be triggered to open by any temperature increase above a threshold. After the PTC switch opens (e.g., creates an open electrical circuit) and electrical power is removed from the PTC, the PTC may reset itself, e.g., by returning to its original (electrically closed) state.
- the PTC switch opens (e.g., creates an open electrical circuit) and electrical power is removed from the PTC, the PTC may reset itself, e.g., by returning to its original (electrically closed) state.
- the PTC switch (e.g., 2212 and/or 2228) allows electrical (e.g., DC) power and communication (e.g., RF) signal to travel through the trunk line during an (e.g., temporary) opening of the switch.
- electrical e.g., DC
- communication e.g., RF
- a network infrastructure comprises a trunk line as part of a cabling network, which trunk line comprises a plurality of distribution junctions.
- the distribution junction can be operatively coupled to at least one controller and/or at least one target device.
- the trunk line may be operatively coupled (e.g., connected to) a power source and/or a control system (e.g., through a control panel).
- the control system comprises at least one controller.
- the control system may be a hierarchical control system.
- Fig. 23 shows an example a network infrastructure for a first cabling network 2300, a second cabling network 2330, and a third cabling network 2360.
- the first cabling network 2300 includes a bus cable 2321 that is connected to a first control panel 2301 .
- the second cabling network 2330 includes a bus cable 2323 that is connected to a second control panel 2303.
- the third cabling network 2360 includes a bus cable 2325 that is connected to a third control panel 2305.
- the first control panel 2301 , second control panel 2303, and third control panel 2305 can each comprise a network (e.g., comprising floor) controller.
- the controller can be a main controller, or a controller lower in the hierarchy of controllers.
- a bus cable can be connected to a plurality of distribution junctions.
- the first bus cable 2321 is connected to eight distribution junctions including a distribution junction 2312.
- the distribution junction 2312 is connected to one or more downstream devices over a branch cable 2315.
- the downstream devices include a first downstream device 2314 (e.g., local controller) and a second downstream device 2316 (e.g., a target device such as a sensor, emitter, antenna, tintable window, or display construct).
- the first cabling network 2300 can use eight distribution junctions to provide eight taps 2318 (e.g., drop lines), where each tap is configured for connection to one or more downstream target devices (e.g., and their local controller(s)).
- the second bus cable 2323 is connected to twelve distribution junctions to provide twelve taps 2320.
- the third bus cable 2325 is connected to sixteen distribution junctions to provide sixteen taps 2322.
- the maximum number of taps can be determined by the current-producing capacity of a source of electrical power. In some embodiments, the maximum number of taps can be determined by the signal to noise ratio of the communication signal reaching from the signal source, to the most distant device from the source (e.g., traveling the longest trunk line distance and/or cabling distance). In some embodiments, the number of taps (e.g., drops) can be at least about 1 , 2, 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, 24, 36, 48, or 72. In some embodiments, the communication signal (e.g.,
- RF power at each of the taps is at most approximately 10 dB, 15 dB, 20 dB, 25 dB, 26 dB, or 30 dB less than the communication signal (e.g., RF) power on the bus cable 2321 (e.g., the trunk line).
- a cabling network may include a network bus (e.g., bus cable 2321 , also referred to herein as a trunk line) and branch cables (e.g., branch cable 2315).
- the network bus and branch cables may distribute one or more time-varying (e.g., communication) signals and/or electrical (e.g., DC) power within a network infrastructure.
- the network bus and branch cables may include one or more signal conductors and one or more ground conductors.
- the network bus may be formed of multiple circuits coupled together.
- a first circuit of the network bus may couple together a controller (e.g., within the first control panel 2301) and a distribution junction (e.g., distribution junction 2312). Second and subsequent circuits of the network bus may couple together respective pairs of distribution junctions.
- a branch cable e.g., branch cable 2315
- branch circuit e.g., branch circuit 2314
- distribution junction e.g., distribution junction 2312
- the network bus and branch cables may (e.g., simultaneously) distribute multiple time-varying signals and/or electrical power.
- the network bus and branch cables may convey electrical (e.g., DC) power at any desired nominal voltage.
- the network bus and branch cables may convey DC power at a voltage of at least about 12 V, at 23V, or at 48 volts (V).
- the network bus and branch cables may follow any International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) class such as class 0, I, II, or III.
- IEC International Electrotechnical Commission
- the network bus and branch cables may abide by class II of IEC and may thus carry a maximum of about 100VA or 100 Watts.
- the network bus and branch cables may have a wire thickness (e.g., 12, 14, 16 or 18 gauge) sufficient to carry the requested current.
- the network bus and branch cables may include shielding (e.g., foil shielding, braided shielding, or quad shielding), e.g., to reduce crosstalk and/or interference.
- the network bus and branch cables may comprise (e.g., be formed from) LMR-200, LMR- 240, LMR-400, RG-6, RG-8, RG-11 , RG-59, RG-60, RG-174, RG-210, RG-213, 8233, or 8267 coaxial cable, or another type of cable suitable for its intended purpose, e.g., as disclosed herein.
- the network bus and/or branch cables may distribute any requested number (e.g., 1 , 2, 3, 4, 5, or more) of distinguishable time-varying signal frequency sets.
- the time-varying signal frequency sets may be distributed over non-overlapping frequencies windows.
- the network bus and/or branch cables may distribute a first frequency set of time-varying signals over one or more first frequency windows and a second set of time-varying signal frequency over one or more second frequency windows.
- Frequency windows (in both the first and second sets) may be separated in the frequency- domain (e.g., there may be guard bands between the frequency windows).
- some frequency windows (from the first and/or second sets) are not separated by a guard band and/or are partially overlapping in the frequency-domain (e.g., one frequency window end contact another frequency window beginning, e.g., Fig. 5, 526 and 529).
- Separating frequency-adjacent frequency windows with guard bands may (i) reduce noise and/or interference, (ii) reduce the cost and/or complexity of network components (e.g., cables, filters, distribution junctions, etc.), or (iii) any combination of (i) and (ii).
- network components e.g., cables, filters, distribution junctions, etc.
- the network distributes time-varying signals.
- the network may distribute a plurality of time varying signal types.
- the first set of time- varying signals distributed by the cabling network may include network data signals (e.g., control related signals).
- the first set of time-varying signals may be digital communications or digital data.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals configured to be transmitted by communications technology that transmits digital information over power lines that used to (e.g., only) deliver electrical power.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals configured to be transmitted by hardware devices designed for communication and transfer of data (e.g., Ethernet, USB and Wi-Fi) through electrical wiring of a building.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals configured to be transmitted by a data transfer protocol that facilitates data transmission rates of at least about 1 Megahertz (MHz), 5 MHz, 10 MHz, 50 MHz, 10 MHz 0, 500 MHz, 1 Gigabits per second (Gbit/s), 2 Gbit/s, 3 Gbit/s, 4 Gbit/s, or 5 Gbit/s.
- the data transfer protocol may operate over telephone wiring, coaxial cables, power lines, and/or (e.g., plastic) optical fiber.
- the data transfer protocol may be facilitated using a chip (e.g., comprising a semiconductor device).
- the first set of time-varying signals may include power line communications signals, such as G.hn, HomePlug®, or HD-PLC compatible signals.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals compatible with the multimedia over coax alliance (MoCA) protocol.
- the first set of time-varying signals may include signals compatible with other protocols including Ethernet protocols such as 802.3bw, 802.3bp, 802.3ch, and/or 802.3cq.
- the first frequency window may extend from approximately 2 Megahertz (MHz) to approximately 200 MHz (e.g., such as used in the G.hn protocol).
- the first frequency window may extend from approximately 500 MHz to approximately 600 MHz, from approximately 875 MHz to approximately 1 Ghz, and/or from approximately 1 .15 to approximately 1 .5 GHz.
- the second set of time-varying signals distributed by the cabling network may include RF signals.
- the second-time varying signals may include signals received by or for transmission through an antenna.
- the second frequency windows may extend from approximately 600 MHz to approximately 1 GHz, from approximately 1 .4 GHz to approximately 6 GHz, from approximately 1 .7 GHz to approximately 6 GHz.
- the radiofrequency signals may include cellular network signals such as fourth-generation (4G) and/or fifth-generation (5G) cellular network signals.
- the 4G and 5G cellular network signals include signals at or below approximately 6 GHz.
- the ranges of the first and second set of time varying signals may overlap.
- the ranges of the first and second set of time varying signals may be separate. The separation may by a signal domain that is not occupied by the first or by the second time varying signals.
- the data plane infrastructure of Fig. 23, including, e.g., the first, second and third control panels 2301 , 2303 and 2305, cabling such as coaxial cables, and network adaptors is used to provide electrical power to nodes on the network.
- electrical power e.g., provided at about 48 volts DC
- the control panel includes a power manager.
- the power manager may be configured to control distribution of power to individual network adaptors and/or end nodes on a network.
- the individual network adaptors or other nodes may be provided power according to a protocol implemented in the power manager.
- the end nodes will not be permitted to draw power whenever they want to (e.g., on demand).
- Various criteria may be employed to decide when and/or how much electrical power to deliver to individual nodes or network adaptors on a network. Such criteria may include, for example, ensuring that the total delivered power on the system does not exceed some threshold, such as a threshold set for a particular electrical standard in the jurisdiction (e.g., of about 100 Watts for class 2 networks in the United States).
- some threshold such as a threshold set for a particular electrical standard in the jurisdiction (e.g., of about 100 Watts for class 2 networks in the United States).
- one or more end nodes connected to the network are not permitted to draw electrical power (or permitted to draw only a limited amount of electrical power) until they have negotiated with the electrical power manager for electrical power.
- the electrical power manager, or another network component may form a virtual network with the end nodes for the purposes of electrical power negotiation and/or network authentication.
- control system is configured to facilitate power control in the cabling network.
- the control may comprise electrical power distribution in time and space domains (e.g., according to business logic and/or device requirements).
- the power manager may be configured to perform operations comprising (i) proposing at least one possible (e.g., optional) schedule for device operation, (ii) considering how long will it take for a given process to occur (from its beginning to its end), (iii) managing (e.g., 3 rd ) party devices in terms of their operational mode and/or timing - for example, considering operational mode (e.g., continuous or intermittent operation), (iv) considering and/or purposing various intermittent operation schemes, (v) considering when devices are required, (vi) interlacing, aligning and/or matching operational requirement and requests of devices, (vii) disabling (e.g., shutting off) a given device that drains power, e.g., above a threshold value, (viii) delaying operation of a given device,
- the device may have the option to request varied (e.g., higher or lower) power budget.
- the power manager e.g., power controller
- the power manager may be configured to propose priority listing of devices for power use.
- the power manager can utilize a pre-made priority listing of devices, e.g., in terms of their power usage.
- the power manager may know where to connect devices (e.g., to which trunk line) in the facility and/or network.
- the trunk line may be able to connect up to 8, 12, 16, or 32 devices, e.g., in series.
- the power manager may facilitate automatic electrical power load distribution.
- the power manager may identify which controller of the control system is connected to which channel and/or to which device(s).
- the device can be a tintable window, a media display (e.g., a transparent display), device ensemble (e.g., a sensor suite), (e.g., cellular) transceiver.
- a media display e.g., a transparent display
- device ensemble e.g., a sensor suite
- the power manager may consider which device is undergoing which operation (e.g., which transition, given IGU type and dimensions).
- the power manager may prioritize the power budget according to business logic.
- the prioritization may comprise product management.
- the prioritization may be based at least in part on (I) a reasonably inferred logic, (II) spaces of the facility (e.g., a space of a kind and/or having a characteristic), (III) occupancy in a space of the facility, (IV) a zone (e.g., occupant zone), (V) device prioritization (e.g., based on device type, device function, and/or device placement in the facility), (VI) external conditions, (VII) amount of power required, (VII) length of time for which power is required, (VIII) voltage draw source identification, or (IX) any combination of (I) to (VIII).
- the prioritization may utilized logic comprising a higher level abstract business logic.
- the prioritization may utilize an occupancy scheme of the facility.
- the prioritization may facilitate a (e.g., structural and/or architectural) model of the facility.
- the model may comprise a Building Information Modeling (BIM) (e.g., Revit file) of the facility or any enclosure therein.
- BIM Building Information Modeling
- the model may comprise two dimensional (e.g., floor plan) and/or three dimensional modeling (e.g., 3D model rendering) of the facility or any enclosure therein.
- the logic may or may not comprise a finite element analysis.
- the logic may comprise, or be utilized in, a simulation.
- the logic may comprise a generalization logic.
- the power manager may utilize artificial intelligence (e.g., ML).
- the ML may consider tint transition type, tint transition time for completion, dimension of the tintable window, and/or material properties of the tintable window (e.g., of the electrochromic construct).
- the ML may consider requested temperature, temperature gradient to requested temperature, enclosure type to adjust temperature, enclosure dimensions, material properties of the fixtures of the enclosure, pressure of the atmosphere of the enclosure, and/or velocity of gas (e.g., air) propelled by the HVAC into and/or out of the enclosure (e.g., room or other facility space).
- the power manager may identify from where the electrical power demand is coming from, e.g., from which device(s).
- the power manager may prioritize the supply of power.
- the power manager may identify the device(s) by their network identification code.
- the power manager utilizes modeling.
- the modeling may be based at least in part on known forms of behavior that can expected from a controller driving particular operations of the device (e.g., transitioning tint of tintable windows, playing a movie on a display construct, adjusting temperature of a room, broadcasting a message).
- the power manager may learn and/or utilize known (e.g., historic) power use of the device(s).
- the historic power usage may be of the device in the facility, of similar devices in the facility, or of similar devices in other facilities.
- the modeling may include a learning stage.
- the modeling may utilize a learning set (e.g., based on real-time data gathering and/or historic data gathering).
- the learning set may comprise synthesized data.
- the learning set may utilize historical information from this or other sites (e.g., having similar network and/or similar devices coupled to the cabling network).
- the power manager may include a hardware and/or software interface.
- the power manager may have a graphical user interface (GUI).
- the program manager may include an application programming interface (API).
- the power manager may receive input from a user, e.g., via an GUI of the API.
- the power manager may solicit and/or accept input regarding a user’s preference in terms of device usage.
- a preference for a tint level of a tintable window at a room of the user may comprise lighting, humidity, temperature, gas velocity, gas pressure, volatile organic compound (VOC) level, particulate level, sound level, or any combination thereof.
- the lighting may comprise lighting intensity, direction, source arrangement, source selection, and/or color.
- the color may comprise color type, color wavelength, or color gradient.
- the power manager may or may not be able to override requests by the user.
- the power manager may not satisfy the user request.
- the GUI may communication (e.g., visually project or sound) to the user a denial of the request.
- the API of the power manager may be installed in a processor of the user, e.g., in a stationary or mobile processor (such as a tablet, mobile phone, or laptop).
- the model may comprise Building Information Modeling (BIM) software (e.g., Autodesk Revit) product (e.g., file).
- BIM Building Information Modeling
- the BIM product may allow a user to design a building with parametric modeling and drafting elements.
- the BIM is a Computer Aided Design (CAD) paradigm that allows for intelligent, 3D and/or parametric object-based design.
- CAD Computer Aided Design
- the BIM model may contain information pertaining to a full life cycle for a building, from concept to construction to decommissioning. This functionality can be provided by the underlying relational database architecture of the BIM model, that may be referred to as the parametric change engine.
- the BIM product may use .RVT files for storing BIM models.
- the BIM e.g., Revit
- the model can capture relationships between components, views, and annotations, such that a change to any element is automatically propagated to keep the model consistent. For example, moving a wall updates neighboring walls, floors, and roofs, corrects the placement and values of dimensions and notes, adjusts the floor areas reported in schedules, redraws section views, etc.
- the BIM may facilitate continuous connection, updates, and/or coordination between the model and (e.g., all) documentation of the facility, e.g., for simplification of update in real time and/or instant revisions of the model.
- the concept of bi-directional associativity between components, views, and annotations can be a feature of BIM.
- the BIM model can use a single file database that can be shared among multiple users. Plans, sections, elevations, legends, and schedules can be interconnected.
- the BIM can provide (e.g., full) bi-directional associativity. Thus, if a user makes a change in one view, the other views can be automatically updated. Likewise, BIM files can be updated automatically in response to an input received from a sensor.
- BIM drawings and/or schedules can be fully coordinated in terms of the building objects shown in drawings.
- a base facility e.g., building
- fixtures e.g., walls, floors, roofs, structure, windows, and/or doors
- the BIM model (e.g., BIM virtual model, or BIM virtual file) can incorporate information regarding the structure and/or material associated with the facility. Generally, if a component of the design is going to be seen in more than one view, it can be created using a 3D object. Users can create their own 3D and 2D objects for modeling and drafting purposes. Small-scale views of building components may be created using a combination of 3D and 2D drafting objects, or by importing drafting work done in another computer aided design (CAD) platform, for example, via DWG, DXF, DGN, SAT or SKP.
- CAD computer aided design
- a central file can be created which stores a master copy of the project database on a file server.
- a user can work on a copy of the central file (known as the local file), stored on his/her workstation. Users can save to the central file to update the central file with their changes, and to receive changes from other users.
- the BIM model can check with the central file whenever a user starts working on an object in the database to see if another user is editing the object. This procedure may prevent two people from making the same change simultaneously and causing a conflict.
- Multiple disciplines working together on the same project can make their own project databases and link in databases from other consultants for verification.
- BIM can perform interference checking, which may detect if different components of the building are occupying the same physical space.
- the BIM model may require manual updates to at least one document associated with the facility to document the change and remain updated.
- the control system e.g., using the sensor(s)) of the facility
- may e.g., automatically feed structural updates to the BIM model, to the logic (e.g., to the Al engine, and/or to the simulation).
- the structural updates fed by the control system may be done in real time (e.g., as the changes occur), or at a time in which the facility is not occupied (e.g., at night, during the weekend, or during a holiday).
- the update may be scheduled (e.g., pre-scheduled).
- the update may take place at a closest time frame to the structural change made (e.g., the first time in which the facility is idle after the structural change has been made).
- the update may be at a predetermined (e.g., pre-scheduled) intervals, and/or sensed by the sensors operatively coupled to the network.
- one or more models are used by the logic (e.g., by the Al engine).
- the model may incorporate non-fixed materials, for example, water that occupies pipes, heat capacity of materials, optical absorbance/reflectivity, heat signature, acoustic properties, and/or outgassing/VoC’s of materials versus temperature.
- the model may incorporate openings, time of day, sun angle, and/or penetration depth.
- the model may be applied to a scenario where room assignments and/or walls are unknown.
- the model may be applied to a scenario where a dry wall, hallway, open area, reception area, stairs, and/or a closed area are known.
- the model may include building elements such as fixtures and non-fixtures.
- the building elements may comprise partitions, walls, floors, roofs, structure, windows, doors, ceilings, cabinets, furniture, desks, cubicles, tables, chairs, ventilation ducts, electrical conduits, lighting fixtures, water supply lines, roof vents, and/or piping for utilities.
- the model may associate a fixture with one or more physical properties, such as a material for the fixture, a heat capacity for the fixture, an acoustical property for the fixture, and/or any of a number of other physical properties.
- the model can include information about the energy-related characteristics of commercial and/or residential buildings.
- the model can include information from a Building Performance Database (BPD) maintained by the U.S. Department of Energy.
- BPD Building Performance Database
- the BPD combines, cleanses and/or anonymizes data collected from buildings by jurisdictional authorities (e.g., federal, state and local governments), utilities, energy efficiency programs, building owners and/or private companies.
- jurisdictional authorities e.g., federal, state and local governments
- utilities e.g., federal, state and local governments
- energy efficiency programs e.g., energy efficiency programs
- building owners and/or private companies e.g., to document trends in energy performance.
- a variety of physical and operational characteristics for a plurality of building types can be stored in the BPD, e.g., to document trends in energy performance.
- the BPD can allow users to create and/or save customized datasets based on specific variables, e.g., including building types, locations, sizes, ages, equipment, and
- the BPD can allow users to compare buildings using statistical or actuarial methods.
- the BPD can comprise a graphical web interface and/or an API (e.g., of the power manager and/or a web API), which may allow applications and/or services to dynamically query the BPD.
- an API e.g., of the power manager and/or a web API
- various target devices are grouped into zones of target devices (e.g., of EC windows).
- At least one zone can include a subset of the target devices (e.g., media displays, sensors, emitters, and/or IGUs).
- at least one (e.g., each) zone of target devices may be controlled by one or more controllers of the control system.
- At least one (e.g., each) zone can be controlled by a single floor controller (e.g., network controller) and two or more local controllers (e.g., window controllers) controlled by the single floor controller.
- a zone can represent a logical grouping of the target devices.
- At least one (e.g., each) zone may correspond to a set of target devices in a specific location or area of the facility that are driven together based at least in part on their location.
- a building may have four faces or sides (a North face, a South face, an East Face, and a West Face) and ten floors.
- each zone may correspond to the set of target devices (e.g., electrochromic windows, antenna, lighting, or vents) on a particular floor and on a particular one of the four faces.
- At least one (e.g., each) zone may correspond to a set of target devices that share one or more physical characteristics (for example, device parameters such as size, material, type, or age).
- a zone of target devices is grouped based at least in part on one or more non-physical characteristics of the target devices such as, for example, placement in the facility, intended purpose, or a security designation or a business hierarchy.
- IGUs bounding managers’ offices can be grouped in one or more zones while IGUs bounding non-managers’ offices can be grouped in one or more different zones.
- the zones may be defined according to occupancy (e.g., occupant zones) in the facility, functionality of various enclosures of the facility (e.g., offices, conference rooms, cafeterias, entrance halls, corridors, laboratories, and the like), non-fixture (e.g., mobile furniture) placement within the enclosure, and/or fixture (e.g., wall) location within the facility.
- occupancy e.g., occupant zones
- enclosures of the facility e.g., offices, conference rooms, cafeterias, entrance halls, corridors, laboratories, and the like
- non-fixture e.g., mobile furniture placement within the enclosure
- fixture e.g., wall
- At least one (e.g., each) floor controller is able to address all of the target devices in at least one (e.g., each) of one or more respective zones.
- the master controller can issue a primary tint command to the floor controller that controls a target zone.
- the primary tint command can include an (e.g., abstract) identification of the target zone (hereinafter also referred to as a “zone ID”).
- the zone ID can be a first protocol ID.
- the floor controller may receive the primary tint command including the tint value and the zone ID.
- the floor controller may map the zone ID to the second protocol IDs associated with the local controllers (e.g., window controllers) within the zone.
- the zone ID is a higher level abstraction than the first protocol IDs.
- the floor controller can first map the zone ID to one or more first protocol IDs, and subsequently map the first protocol IDs to the second protocol IDs.
- an electrical power management protocol may employ a defined set of communications between the electrical power manager and one or more network adaptors or nodes. For examples, requests for electrical power may be issued by network adaptors and requests for information may be issued by an electrical power manager. Data containing the timing and/or conditions of electrical power delivery, may be issued from the electrical power manager before electrical power is actually delivered. In certain embodiments, such communications are provided using the (e.g., G.hn) communications protocol. Power over Ethernet (PoA) may be implemented with its own protocol. In certain embodiments, a link layer discovery protocol (LLDP) is employed to provide the relevant communications for electrical power management, whether or not using a Power over Ethernet protocol.
- LLDP link layer discovery protocol
- Fig. 24 shows an example of a flowchart depicting an illustrative method 2400 of utilizing a distribution junction.
- a distribution junction may be provided.
- the distribution junction may couple a trunk line to one or more branch lines.
- the trunk line may comprise a first cable that transmits electrical power and/or communication.
- the branch line(s) may comprise a second cable that transmits electrical power and/or communication.
- the transmission of electrical power and/or communication may be to one or more devices.
- the one or more devices can be coupled to the branch line(s).
- the distribution junction can be disposed along the trunk line.
- the electrical power may be DC power.
- electrical (e.g., DC) power request(s) can be received from the device(s).
- Electrical power requirement(s) of the devices can be received.
- the electrical current transmitted to the device(s) can be controlled. The control can be based at least in part on the electrical power request(s) and/or the power requirement(s) of the device(s).
- the electrical current and the communication may be transmitted and directed along the trunk line cable and/or to the device(s) through the distribution junction.
- Fig. 25 is a flowchart depicting an illustrative method 2500 of managing a device.
- the device can be a third-party device, an internal device of the facility and/or network provider.
- the order of operations is unrestricted. The operations may be performed in any order, as applicable.
- a time schedule for operation of the device may be formulated.
- a determination can be made of the duration of time it will take for a given process to be executed on the device (e.g., how much time will it take for a tintable window to reach a requested tint level, or how much time will it take to cool an environment of a room to a requested temperature level).
- a determination can be made of an operational mode and/or an operational scheme for execution of the operation on and/or by the device.
- an operational mode can specify a continuous operation or an (regularly or irregularly) intermittent operation.
- the determination of block 2505 can be based at least in part on operation of at least one other device operatively coupled to the network.
- two or more operational modes may be timewise interlaced (e.g., operational modes of two or more devices may be interlaced in time). Requests can be interlaced for at least one other device coupled to a network on which the device is coupled.
- a first device may receive intermittent power at a frequency
- a second device may receive intermittent power at the frequency
- the two power frequency may be adjusted such that when the first device does not receive power, the second device will receive power.
- the given operation may be executed on the device at block 2509.
- Fig. 26 shows an example of a flowchart depicting an illustrative method 2600 of prioritizing a power budget for a device.
- a procedure may be performed to identify one or more physical entities that are used to operatively couple the control system to a channel of a plurality of channels, and/or to a device of a plurality of devices.
- the control system can be operatively coupled to a device via a trunk line, a distribution junction, and a branch cable.
- a power budget may be prioritized for the device and/or the channel according to a logic.
- the logic may include (I) business logic, (II) spatial designation, (III) device specification, (IV) device power request, (V) a schedule, (VI) external conditions, (VII) device power requirements (e.g., an amount of power and/or a timing for the power), (VIII) power request, and/or (VIII) predicted power usage by the device (e.g., using machine learning (ML), scheduling, and/or historical data).
- the spatial designation may comprise prioritization of spaces, a space of a kind, a space having a characteristic, an occupancy level, and/or an occupancy zone.
- the logic may include product management and/or one or more reasonable inferences.
- the historical data can be drawn from the control system (e.g., from the local controller) that services the device.
- the power budget prioritization determined at block 2603 can be used to generate a power distribution scheme or plan for the device and/or the channel.
- the control system can be used to distribute, or direct distribution of, power to the device and/or to the channel.
- Fig. 27 shows an example of a flowchart depicting an illustrative method 2700 of managing power distribution for a device.
- a priority listing of devices for power usage may be defined at block 2701.
- power usage may comprise electrical power usage such as consumption of electrical (e.g., DC) power.
- Power usage can comprise communication signal (e.g., RF) power usage.
- the priority listing can be defined at least in part using business logic (for example, such as described with reference to block 2603 of Fig. 26).
- power distribution can be monitored for devices coupled to a network. This power distribution may comprise electrical power and/or communication signal power.
- the method 2700 Upon detecting that the device is draining power above a threshold value (e.g., DC power and/or RF power), the method 2700 advances to block 2715 where the device is disconnected from electrical power and/or communication signal power (e.g., respectively - depending on the type of power drainage). Otherwise, the method 2700 advances from block 2703 to block 2705 where a power budget request is received from the device(s). In some embodiments, the power budget request can be for an altered power budget. At block 2707, the power budget request may be considered along with any other power budget request(s). A distribution status of the power within the network (e.g., DC power and/or RF power) can be considered, along with a distribution projection of the power within the network at a future time.
- a threshold value e.g., DC power and/or RF power
- a historic power usage of the device(s) in the network may be considered, along with any power usage trends of the device(s).
- the power usage trends may be compiled using artificial intelligence, e.g., using a machine learning (ML) module.
- ML machine learning
- a result is generated pertaining to the power distribution of the requesting device(s).
- the method advances to either block 2711 or block 2713.
- power e.g., DC power and/or RF power
- the intermittent power may be supplied at regular or irregular intervals.
- a continuous power supply to the requesting device(s) can be delayed.
- Fig. 28 is a flowchart depicting an illustrative method of managing devices in the context of tintable windows.
- devices e.g., tintable windows, media display, sensors, lighting, alarm system, or HVAC system
- the devices can be coupled to a control system and to a network.
- one or more models may be generated using known forms of operation of the devices (e.g., a transition of tintable windows, adjusting temperature of a room, displaying media, sounding alarm, or sensing).
- the modeling can include Artificial Intelligence (Al) such as ML.
- information is gathered from (i) historic measurements, (ii) synthesized measurements, and/or (iii) hardware and/or firmware of the control system (e.g., local controller), to generate a training set utilized by the Al engine.
- the training set is used in the model(s) to predict power usage of the devices at a future time (block 2807). Power is delivered to the devices based at least in part on the prediction of the usage of power by the devices at the future time, in block 2809.
- the devices are (e.g., manually) installed by an installer.
- the tintable (e.g., optically switchable) windows may be installed by an installer (e.g., glazier).
- the installer e.g., a glazier or suitably skilled technician
- branch targets e.g., devices
- electrical power supply connections such as AC power supply connections
- the installer can be an electrician licensed to work with low-voltage electrical systems, e.g., in the jurisdiction in which the building is located.
- the installer can be an electrician licensed to work with high-voltage electrical systems, e.g., in the jurisdiction in which the building is located.
- Wiring e.g., coaxial cabling
- the installer can be installed by such an installer, or it may be installed by an installer who is an electrician or tradesperson permitted to work with lower voltages or powers (e.g. a low-voltage electrician) in the jurisdiction in which the building is constructed.
- the term “licensed electrician” is used herein to refer to an electrician authorized to carry out both low and high voltage and/or power (i.e. class 1 and class 2) installations in the given jurisdiction.
- an installer installs optically switchable windows in the skin of a building in such a way that optically switchable window connectors (e.g. pigtail cables of each window) extend out of the window curtainwall into plenum space.
- the installer can install interior vertical mullion channels between adjacent optically switchable windows and lays wiring (e.g., RG-6 coaxial cable) drop lines through the mullion channels, coiling excess wiring (e.g., RG-6 coaxial cable) in the plenum space.
- the installer may install target(s) (e.g., sensor devices) in the vertical mullions, connected to the wiring drop lines.
- Such targets may be connected to the wiring drop lines at a different (e.g., later) time.
- An installer e.g., licensed electrician
- distributed control panels e.g., in the plenum space or open space around the perimeter of the building to form the primary ring and optionally, in the interior of the building to form a secondary ring.
- the installer can connect the distributed control panels to a high-voltage AC power supply and can install a wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cabling) that form the primary (and, if present, secondary) ring.
- An installer e.g., low-voltage electrician
- the installer e.g., low-voltage electrician
- At least a portion (e.g., all) of the electrical installation work is carried out by a licensed electrician.
- the design of the network topologies shown in, for example, Figs. 16A, 17A, 17B, and 18 enable an unlicensed electrician or other type of tradesperson to install much of the network once the primary ring of distributed control panels has been installed and/or connected up to the power supply, e.g., during construction of the building framework and/or skin or (e.g., shortly) thereafter. Shortly thereafter may be before occupants inhabit the building, and/or before the building is released for occupation. Accordingly, the overall cost of installing the network of targets (e.g., devices) is reduced.
- targets e.g., devices
- branch targets e.g., devices
- the cabling network may be coupled to an antenna.
- the antenna can be coupled to the trunk line extending from the control panel before any distribution junction (T junction) or other devices (that add loss) are coupled to the trunk line.
- Amplifiers and/or pre-amplifies can be included in the control panel (e.g., of a head controller such as a network controller).
- Passive antennas can be coupled (e.g., anywhere) on the cabling network, e.g., for DAS-like operation. The signal damping can be reduced at the antenna level and/or at the distribution junction level.
- Reduction of the signal damping at the distribution junction level may increase a probability that the signal will be distinct (e.g., distinguishable over the noise) after long distance from the source antenna and/or passage through (e.g., many) junctions.
- Reduction of the signal damping at the antenna level may add cost, power, and/or heat for local amplification and/or filtering.
- the cabling system may be coupled to an external antenna.
- the external antenna may be an active antenna.
- the active antenna may comprise a signal amplifier and pre-amplifier.
- the active antenna may minimize signal coupling (e.g., by the distribution junctions) from antenna to control panel, e.g., by directly connecting the external antenna to the control panel and/or by placing antennas upstream of other devices, such as before the distribution junction, on the first or one of the distribution junctions along the trunk line.
- the amplifier and/or pre-amplifier may utilize RF power.
- the active antenna may increase a probability that the signal traveling in the cabling system is strong enough to be deciphered (e.g., above noise level), and weak enough to abide by jurisdictional safety restrictions and cabling specification.
- the active antennas may add noise and/or signal distortion.
- the active antenna may complicate the link budget and/or tuning to avoid interference, oscillations, or both interference and oscillations.
- the (e.g., external) antenna is a passive
- the cabling system may be coupled to an internal antenna.
- the internal antenna may be an active antenna (e.g., having RF power amplifier and/or pre-amplifier) or a passive antenna.
- the internal antenna may be a dome antenna, antenna coupled or inscribed on a window, in a window frame (e.g., mullion). Bus bars of the IGU can serve as antenna.
- 5G communication signal may have a low divergence angle, requiring a plurality of antennas to provide (e.g., cellular) reception coverage (e.g., may require line of site with cell phone).
- the internal antenna may comprise a dome antennas, e.g., disposed on a corner of an enclosure.
- the internal antenna may be part of a distributed antenna system (DAS).
- DAS distributed antenna system
- the antenna may comprise a MIMO antenna.
- the internal antennas may require a (e.g., dedicated) distribution junction (e.g., a distribution junction having about 50 ohm resistance).
- the antenna may comprise a transformer that provides impedance matching to the cabling system.
- the signal communication e.g. 5G signal below about 6GHz
- the signal communication e.g., 5G millimeter wave
- the signal communication (e.g., 5G millimeter wave) may utilize directional antenna arrays (e.g., 2x2, 4x4 Multi-/Massive-MIMO, having at least 16, 32, 64, or 128 elements).
- the protocol(s) used to transmit data to the branch devices may be selected based at least in part on the data transmission speeds required.
- a branch device such as a weather sensor may require high-speed data communication.
- coaxial cable network branches including branch devices requiring high-speed data communication may include high-speed devices such as ones configured to implement the G.hn protocol.
- a MoCA headend device is installed in the headend unit in the corresponding distributed control panel and a MoCA transceiver is installed at each branch device (and/or at the corresponding device controller) to receive and/or transmit MoCA communications.
- MoCA 2.5 standard enables data transmission at rates of up about 2.5 Gbit/s across different frequency bands (for example, the MoCA AA band corresponds to frequencies of from about 400 MHz to about 900 MHz, while the MoCA AC band corresponds to frequencies of from about 110 MHz to about 1660 MHz).
- an end device such as an electrochromic window may (e.g., only) require low-speed data communication.
- coaxial cable network branches including branch devices requiring lower-speed data communication may include low-speed devices such as G.hn devices.
- a G.hn headend device may be provided in the headend unit in the corresponding distributed control panel.
- a G.hn transceiver may be installed at each branch device (and/or at the corresponding device controller), e.g., to receive and/or transmit G.hn communications.
- G.hn standard may enable data transmission at rates of up to about 2 Gbit/s, transmission rates may (e.g., only) be up to about 200 Mbit/s in practice.
- G.hn devices may transmit data over a frequency band from about 10 MHz to about 70 MHz.
- transmission of data across different frequency bands may be achieved, e.g., by communicating using multiple protocols simultaneously (for example by transmitting a first signal frequency set compliant with MoCA protocol, and transmitting a second signal frequency set compliant with G.hn protocol).
- Appropriately tuned filters e.g., Inductor and Capacitor filters (LC filters)
- LC filters can be used to selectively inject signals in desired communication bands from the coaxial cable branch line into the appropriate drop lines, or to hinder (e.g., block) transmission of PLC signals, e.g., to avoid interference such as when different branch devices are controlled on a single branch line.
- Power inserts may be used to maintain power, supplement power, and/or increase density.
- a control panel On a given branch line, there may be inserts directly from a control panel.
- a first portion of (e.g., three) devices closest to the control panel may receive power directly from the main power line (e.g., not from a power insert).
- the device closest to the control panel may receive power directly from the control panel
- the device second closest to the control panel receives power downstream from a tap providing power to the first device
- the device third closest to the control panel receives power downstream from a tap providing power to the second device.
- the power distribution system may include a power insert between taps for the third and fourth devices on the branch line (e.g., to supplement adequate supply of power such as for the targets).
- the fourth device can receive some or all of its power via the power insert.
- elements of a vertical data plane network are installed in the skin of the building, for example during or (e.g., immediately) following the initial construction of the building framework and/or skin.
- one or more elements of the wiring such as the first wiring (e.g., fiber optic or other cabling of the) ring, the second wiring (e.g., coaxial or other cabling) of network branch lines and/or drop lines, the distributed control panels and/or the branch devices) are installed in the skin of the building.
- the branch targets are devices such as tintable (e.g., optically switchable) windows, sensors or security devices which can be installed in the skin of the building.
- optically switchable windows may form part of a curtainwall which surrounds the building.
- Sensors, emitters, and/or security devices may be installed in a curtainwall, for example in frames (such as vertical mullions or channels and/or horizontal sashes or transoms) which surround windows.
- Sensors, emitters, and/or security devices can be installed in the interior of the building.
- Windows e.g., tintable windows
- optically switchable windows are installed in the skin of a building, thereby forming a curtainwall fagade which surrounds the framework of the building.
- Coaxial cabling (such as RG-6 coaxial cabling) drop lines may be connected to at least one of (e.g., each) optically switchable window.
- the coaxial cabling drop lines can extend away from the optically switchable windows, out of the curtainwall, into a space provided between structural floors or ceilings of the building framework and corresponding raised floors or dropped ceilings (e.g., a plenum space of the building (e.g.,).
- Distributed control panels can also be installed in the plenum space, or in other open spaces of the building, spaced apart from one another around the perimeter of the building to form nodes of a primary ring.
- each distributed control panel may be separated from each adjacent distributed control panel around the primary ring by a plurality of (e.g. two or more, three or more, four or more, five or more or six or more) targets such as optically switchable windows.
- the distributed control panels may be fixedly attached (e.g. bolted) to the building framework, for example to structural support columns of the building framework.
- AC power supply lines can be installed and/or connected to the distributed control panels.
- Wiring e.g., fiber optic or other cabling
- Wiring can be installed in the plenum space around the perimeter of the building, e.g., connecting the distributed control panels to form a primary ring.
- Wiring (e.g., Coaxial cabling such as RG-11 coaxial cabling) branch lines can also be installed in the plenum space around the perimeter of the building.
- the wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) drop lines can be connected to the wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) branch lines, e.g., by way of one or more distribution junctions (e.g., inductive taps).
- the wiring (e.g., coaxial cable) branch lines can be connected to the corresponding distributed control panels.
- Secondary network rings in the interior of the building are installed. Secondary network rings may be installed at the same time as installation of the primary ring around the perimeter of the building, or at a different (e.g., later) time, for example when interior walls of the building are being constructed.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Structural Engineering (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
- Signal Processing (AREA)
- Nonlinear Science (AREA)
- Civil Engineering (AREA)
- Architecture (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Optics & Photonics (AREA)
- Power Engineering (AREA)
- Remote Monitoring And Control Of Power-Distribution Networks (AREA)
- Cable Transmission Systems, Equalization Of Radio And Reduction Of Echo (AREA)
Abstract
Description
Claims
Applications Claiming Priority (5)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US202062977001P | 2020-02-14 | 2020-02-14 | |
US202062978755P | 2020-02-19 | 2020-02-19 | |
US202063027452P | 2020-05-20 | 2020-05-20 | |
US202163146365P | 2021-02-05 | 2021-02-05 | |
PCT/US2021/017946 WO2021163552A1 (en) | 2020-02-14 | 2021-02-12 | Data and power network of a facility |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
EP4103809A1 true EP4103809A1 (en) | 2022-12-21 |
EP4103809A4 EP4103809A4 (en) | 2024-05-01 |
Family
ID=77292958
Family Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
EP21752901.5A Pending EP4103809A4 (en) | 2020-02-14 | 2021-02-12 | Data and power network of a facility |
Country Status (7)
Country | Link |
---|---|
EP (1) | EP4103809A4 (en) |
JP (1) | JP2023515391A (en) |
KR (1) | KR20220157953A (en) |
CN (1) | CN115315563A (en) |
CA (1) | CA3167832A1 (en) |
TW (1) | TW202202720A (en) |
WO (1) | WO2021163552A1 (en) |
Families Citing this family (1)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
CN117178227A (en) * | 2020-10-27 | 2023-12-05 | 唯景公司 | Failure prediction for at least one tintable window |
Family Cites Families (9)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6032020A (en) * | 1997-07-28 | 2000-02-29 | Motorola, Inc. | Multi-repeater communication system |
FI104134B1 (en) * | 1997-07-31 | 1999-11-15 | Nokia Networks Oy | Data and power supply realizing cable adaptation |
US6956826B1 (en) * | 1999-07-07 | 2005-10-18 | Serconet Ltd. | Local area network for distributing data communication, sensing and control signals |
WO2002007365A2 (en) * | 2000-07-13 | 2002-01-24 | Nxegen | System and method for monitoring and controlling energy usage |
US7034662B2 (en) * | 2003-09-15 | 2006-04-25 | Rockwell Automation Technologies, Inc. | Multi-function integrated automation cable system and method |
US10303035B2 (en) * | 2009-12-22 | 2019-05-28 | View, Inc. | Self-contained EC IGU |
US20140368899A1 (en) * | 2013-06-18 | 2014-12-18 | Sage Electrochromics, Inc. | Control system trunk line architecture |
US11743071B2 (en) * | 2018-05-02 | 2023-08-29 | View, Inc. | Sensing and communications unit for optically switchable window systems |
US11003041B2 (en) * | 2014-06-30 | 2021-05-11 | View, Inc. | Power management for electrochromic window networks |
-
2021
- 2021-02-12 WO PCT/US2021/017946 patent/WO2021163552A1/en unknown
- 2021-02-12 CN CN202180024378.3A patent/CN115315563A/en active Pending
- 2021-02-12 JP JP2022549096A patent/JP2023515391A/en active Pending
- 2021-02-12 CA CA3167832A patent/CA3167832A1/en active Pending
- 2021-02-12 EP EP21752901.5A patent/EP4103809A4/en active Pending
- 2021-02-12 KR KR1020227031677A patent/KR20220157953A/en active Search and Examination
- 2021-02-17 TW TW110105368A patent/TW202202720A/en unknown
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
WO2021163552A1 (en) | 2021-08-19 |
EP4103809A4 (en) | 2024-05-01 |
CN115315563A (en) | 2022-11-08 |
KR20220157953A (en) | 2022-11-29 |
TW202202720A (en) | 2022-01-16 |
CA3167832A1 (en) | 2021-08-19 |
JP2023515391A (en) | 2023-04-13 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US20230074720A1 (en) | Data and power network of a facility | |
US11294254B2 (en) | Building network | |
US12087997B2 (en) | Antenna systems for controlled coverage in buildings | |
US20220179275A1 (en) | Building network | |
TW202333483A (en) | Edge network for building services | |
US20230194115A1 (en) | Environmental adjustment using artificial intelligence | |
US20230367584A1 (en) | COMPONENT UPDATES IN A MULTl COMPONENT NETWORK | |
CA3169929A1 (en) | Environmental adjustment using artificial intelligence | |
EP4103809A1 (en) | Data and power network of a facility | |
US20240192563A1 (en) | Dynamic signal routing in a facility | |
WO2024206638A1 (en) | Data and power network of a facility | |
TW202314652A (en) | Locally initiated wireless emergency alerts | |
TW202225807A (en) | Failure prediction of at least one tintable window | |
US20240276204A1 (en) | Providing enhanced cellular communication in a facility | |
TW202329718A (en) | Providing enhanced cellular communication in a facility | |
Hintersteiner | The Application of Axiomatic Design to Complex Wi-Fi Systems |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
STAA | Information on the status of an ep patent application or granted ep patent |
Free format text: STATUS: THE INTERNATIONAL PUBLICATION HAS BEEN MADE |
|
PUAI | Public reference made under article 153(3) epc to a published international application that has entered the european phase |
Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009012 |
|
STAA | Information on the status of an ep patent application or granted ep patent |
Free format text: STATUS: REQUEST FOR EXAMINATION WAS MADE |
|
17P | Request for examination filed |
Effective date: 20220809 |
|
AK | Designated contracting states |
Kind code of ref document: A1 Designated state(s): AL AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR HR HU IE IS IT LI LT LU LV MC MK MT NL NO PL PT RO RS SE SI SK SM TR |
|
DAV | Request for validation of the european patent (deleted) | ||
DAX | Request for extension of the european patent (deleted) | ||
P01 | Opt-out of the competence of the unified patent court (upc) registered |
Effective date: 20230519 |
|
A4 | Supplementary search report drawn up and despatched |
Effective date: 20240402 |
|
RIC1 | Information provided on ipc code assigned before grant |
Ipc: H04B 3/54 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: E06B 3/67 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: H01Q 9/40 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: H01Q 1/38 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: H01Q 9/04 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: H01Q 1/44 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: H01Q 1/12 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: G02F 1/163 20060101ALI20240325BHEP Ipc: E06B 9/24 20060101AFI20240325BHEP |